blob: 7543cc3fb490df62f42e74e18f08c39d681f4b1d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaua257a9b2019-05-15 16:51:48 +02007 2019/05/15
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200574 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200576 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200577 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100579 - presetenv
580 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200581 - uid
582 - ulimit-n
583 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200584 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100585 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200586 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200588 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - ssl-default-bind-options
590 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200591 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - ssl-default-server-options
593 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100594 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100595 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100596 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100597 - 51degrees-data-file
598 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200599 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200600 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200601 - wurfl-data-file
602 - wurfl-information-list
603 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200604 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200607 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200609 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100610 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100611 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100612 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200613 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200614 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200615 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - noepoll
618 - nokqueue
619 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100620 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300621 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000622 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100623 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200624 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200625 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200626 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000627 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000628 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - tune.buffers.limit
630 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200631 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200632 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100633 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200634 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200635 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200636 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100637 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200638 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200639 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100640 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100642 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.session-timeout
644 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200645 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100646 - tune.maxaccept
647 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200649 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200650 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.rcvbuf.client
652 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100653 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200654 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100655 - tune.sndbuf.client
656 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100657 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200659 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200661 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200662 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100663 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100665 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
667 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
668 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100669 - tune.zlib.memlevel
670 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 * Debugging
673 - debug
674 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675
676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678------------------------------------
679
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680ca-base <dir>
681 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200682 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
683 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685chroot <jail dir>
686 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
687 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
688 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
689 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
690 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100691 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100692
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100693cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
694 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
695 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
696 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
697 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
698 set. These sets have the format
699
700 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
701
702 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100704 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
705 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100706 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
707 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100709 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
713 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
714 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
715 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100717 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
718 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
719 on the machine's word size.
720
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100721 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
723 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
724 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
725 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
726 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
727 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100728
729 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
731
732 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
733 # first 4 CPUs
734
735 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
736 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
737 # word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
743 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
744
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100745 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
746 # and so on.
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100752 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
753 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
754 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
755
756 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
757 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
759
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
761 # and a thread range.
762 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
764 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
765
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200766crt-base <dir>
767 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
768 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
769 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771daemon
772 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
773 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100774 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
775 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777deviceatlas-json-file <path>
778 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200780
781deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100782 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200783 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
784
785deviceatlas-separator <char>
786 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
787 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
788
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100789deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200790 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
791 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
792 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900794external-check
795 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
796 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
797 See "option external-check".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799gid <number>
800 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
801 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
802 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100803 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
804 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100806
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100807hard-stop-after <time>
808 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
809
810 Arguments :
811 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
812 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
813 SIGUSR1 signal.
814
815 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
816 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
817 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
818
819 Example:
820 global
821 hard-stop-after 30s
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823group <group name>
824 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
825 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200827log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
828 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100829 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100830 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100831 configured with "log global".
832
833 <address> can be one of:
834
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100835 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100836 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
837 port).
838
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100839 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
840 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
841 port).
842
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100843 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100844 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
845 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100846 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100847
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100848 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
849 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
850 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
851 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
852 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
853 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
854 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
855 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
856 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
857 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
858 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
859 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
860 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
861 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100862 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
863 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100864
865 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
866 "fd@2", see above.
867
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200868 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
869 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100870
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200871 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
872 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
873 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
874 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
875 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
876 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
877 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
878 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
879 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
880 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100881 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
882 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200883
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200884 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
885 one of the following :
886
887 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
888 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
889
890 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
891 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
892
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100893 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
894 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
895 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
896 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
897 logger consumes.
898
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100899 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
900 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
901 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
902 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
903
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200904 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
905 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
906 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
907 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
908 set with <sample_size> parameter.
909
910 <sample_size>
911 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
912 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
913 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
914 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
915 (see also <ranges> parameter).
916
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100917 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200918
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100919 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
920 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
921 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
922
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100923 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
924 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
925 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
926 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200927
928 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200929 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
930 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
931 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
932 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
933 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
934 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200935
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200936 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200937
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100938log-send-hostname [<string>]
939 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
940 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
941 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
942 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
943 the logs.
944
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000945log-tag <string>
946 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
947 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
948 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100949 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000950
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100951lua-load <file>
952 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
953 used multiple times.
954
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100955master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200956 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
957 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
958 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100959 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200960 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
961 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100962 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
963 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
964 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
965 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
966 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200967
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100968 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200969
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200970mworker-max-reloads <number>
971 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
972 survive to a reload. If the worker did not left after a reload, once its
973 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
974 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
975 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
976
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200977nbproc <number>
978 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
979 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
980 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100981 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
982 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100983 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
984 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200985
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200986nbthread <number>
987 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100988 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
989 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
990 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
991 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
992 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100993 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
994 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
995 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
996 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
997 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
998 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
999 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001000
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001001pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001002 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1004 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1005
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001006presetenv <name> <value>
1007 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1008 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1009 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1010 and "unsetenv".
1011
1012resetenv [<name> ...]
1013 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1014 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1015 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1016 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1017 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1018 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1019 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1020 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1021
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001022stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001023 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1024 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1025 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1026 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1027 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1028 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001029 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001030 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1031 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1032 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1033 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001034
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001035server-state-base <directory>
1036 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001037 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1038 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001039
1040server-state-file <file>
1041 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1042 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1043 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1044 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1045 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1046 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1047 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1048 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001049 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1050 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001051
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001052setenv <name> <value>
1053 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1054 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1055 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1056 and "unsetenv".
1057
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001058set-dumpable
1059 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1060 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1061 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1062 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1063 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1064 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1065 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1066 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1067 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1068 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1069 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1070 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1071 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1072 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1073 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1074 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1075 expected when dying.
1076
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001077ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1078 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1079 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001080 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001081 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001082 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1083 information and recommendations see e.g.
1084 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1085 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1086 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1087 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001088
1089ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1090 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1091 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1092 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1093 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1094 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001095 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1096 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1097 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001098 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001099
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001100ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1101 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1102 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1103 keyword to see available options.
1104
1105 Example:
1106 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001107 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001108
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001109ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1111 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001112 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001113 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001114 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1115 information and recommendations see e.g.
1116 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1117 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1118 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1119 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1120 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001121
1122ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1123 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1124 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1125 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1126 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1127 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001128 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1129 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1130 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1131 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001132
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001133ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1134 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1135 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1136 keyword to see available options.
1137
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001138ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1139 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1140 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1141 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001142 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001143 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001144 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1145 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1146 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1147 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001148 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1149 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1150 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1151
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001152ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1153 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1154 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1155 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1156
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001157stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1158 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1159 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1160 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001161 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001162 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001163
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001164 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1165 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1166 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001167
1168stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1169 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1170 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001171 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001172
1173stats maxconn <connections>
1174 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1175 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177uid <number>
1178 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1179 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1180 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1181 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1182
1183ulimit-n <number>
1184 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1185 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1186 option.
1187
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001188unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1189 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1190
1191 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1192 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1193 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1194 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1195 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1196 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1197 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1198 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1199 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1200 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1201
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001202unsetenv [<name> ...]
1203 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1204 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1205 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1206 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1207 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1208 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1209 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1210
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001211user <user name>
1212 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1213 See also "uid" and "group".
1214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001215node <name>
1216 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1217
1218 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1219 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1220 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1221 traffic.
1222
1223description <text>
1224 Add a text that describes the instance.
1225
1226 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1227 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1228 "<" and ">" characters.
1229
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100123051degrees-data-file <file path>
1231 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001232 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001233
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001234 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001235 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1236
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000123751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001238 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1239 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1240 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1241
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001242 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001243 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1244
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200124551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001246 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1247 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1248
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001249 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1250 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1251
125251degrees-cache-size <number>
1253 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1254 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1255 By default, this cache is disabled.
1256
1257 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001258 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1259
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001260wurfl-data-file <file path>
1261 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1262 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1263
1264 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1265 with USE_WURFL=1.
1266
1267wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1268 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1269 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1270 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1271
1272 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1273
1274 Valid WURFL properties are:
1275 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1276
1277 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1278 device.
1279
1280 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1281 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1282
1283 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1284 particular web request.
1285
1286 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1287 used Libwurfl API version.
1288
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001289 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1290 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1291
1292 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1293 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1294
1295 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1296
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001297 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1298 with USE_WURFL=1.
1299
1300wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1301 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1302 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1303
1304 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1305 with USE_WURFL=1.
1306
1307wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1308 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1309 thus before the chroot.
1310
1311 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1312 with USE_WURFL=1.
1313
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001314wurfl-cache-size <size>
1315 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1316 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001317 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001318 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001319
1320 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1321 with USE_WURFL=1.
1322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013233.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001324-----------------------
1325
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001326busy-polling
1327 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1328 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1329 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1330 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1331 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1332 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1333 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1334 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1335 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1336 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1337 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1338 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1339 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1340 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1341 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1342 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1343 "poll" pollers.
1344
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001345max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1346 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1347 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1348 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1349 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1350 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1351 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1352 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1353 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1354
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001355maxconn <number>
1356 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1357 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1358 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001359 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1360 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1361 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1362 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001363 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1364 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1365 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1366 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1367 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1368 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001369
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001370maxconnrate <number>
1371 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1372 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1373 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1374 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1375 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1376 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1377 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1378 fairness.
1379
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001380maxcomprate <number>
1381 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001382 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001383 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1384 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1385 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001386 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001387 default value.
1388
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001389maxcompcpuusage <number>
1390 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1391 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1392 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1393 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1394 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1395 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1396 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1397 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1398
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001399maxpipes <number>
1400 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1401 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1402 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1403 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1404 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1405 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1406
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001407maxsessrate <number>
1408 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1409 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1410 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1411 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1412 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1413 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1414 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1415 fairness.
1416
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001417maxsslconn <number>
1418 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1419 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1420 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1421 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1422 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1423 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1424 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001425 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1426 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1427 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1428 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1429 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1430 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1431 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001432
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001433maxsslrate <number>
1434 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1435 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1436 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1437 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1438 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1439 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1440 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1441 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1442 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1443 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1444
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001445maxzlibmem <number>
1446 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1447 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1448 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001449 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1450 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1451 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1452
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001453noepoll
1454 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1455 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001456 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001457
1458nokqueue
1459 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1460 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1461 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1462
1463nopoll
1464 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1465 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001466 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001467 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001468
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001469nosplice
1470 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001471 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001472 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001473 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001474 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1475 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1476 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1477 "option splice-response".
1478
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001479nogetaddrinfo
1480 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1481 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1482
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001483noreuseport
1484 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1485 command line argument "-dR".
1486
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001487profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1488 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1489 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1490 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1491 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
1492 reutnrs below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
1493 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1494 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1495 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1496 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1497
1498 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1499 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1500 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1501 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1502 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001503 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1504 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1505 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1506 CLI.
1507
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001508spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001509 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1510 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1511 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1512 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1513 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1514 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001515
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001516ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001517 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001518 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001519 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1520 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1521 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1522 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1523 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001524 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1525 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001526 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1527 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1528 openssl configuration file uses:
1529 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1530
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001531ssl-mode-async
1532 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001533 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001534 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1535 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1536 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1537 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1538 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001539
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001540tune.buffers.limit <number>
1541 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1542 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1543 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1544 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1545 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001546 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001547 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1548 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1549 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1550 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1551 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1552 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1553 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1554 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1555 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1556
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001557tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1558 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1559 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1560 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1561 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1562
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001563tune.bufsize <number>
1564 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1565 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1566 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1567 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1568 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1569 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1570 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001571 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1572 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1573 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001574 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001575 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1576 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1577 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001578
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001579tune.chksize <number>
1580 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1581 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1582 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1583 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1584 checks whenever possible.
1585
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001586tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1587 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1588 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1589 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1590 this value. The default value is 1.
1591
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001592tune.fail-alloc
1593 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1594 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1595 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1596 gracefully.
1597
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001598tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1599 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1600 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1601 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1602 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1603 change it.
1604
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001605tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1606 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001607 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1608 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001609 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1610 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1611 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1612 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1613 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1614
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001615tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1616 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1617 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1618 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1619 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1620 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1621 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1622 recommended not to change this value.
1623
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001624tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1625 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1626 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1627 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1628 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1629 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1630 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1631 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1632
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001633tune.http.cookielen <number>
1634 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1635 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1636 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1637 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1638 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1639 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1640 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1641 to change this value.
1642
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001643tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001644 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1645 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001646 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001647 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001648 configuration directives too.
1649 The default value is 1024.
1650
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001651tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1652 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1653 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1654 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1655 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1656 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1657 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001658 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1659 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1660 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001661
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001662tune.idletimer <timeout>
1663 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1664 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1665 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1666 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1667 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1668 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001669 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001670 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1671 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1672
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001673tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1674 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1675 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1676 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1677 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1678 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1679 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1680 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1681 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1682 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1683
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001684tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1685 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001686 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001687 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1688 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001689 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001690 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1691 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1692
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001693tune.lua.maxmem
1694 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1695 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1696 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1697 memory.
1698
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001699tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1700 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001701 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1702 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001703 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001704
1705tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1706 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1707 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1708 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1709 check servers.
1710
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001711tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1712 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1713 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1714 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001715 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001716
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001717tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001718 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1719 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1720 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1721 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1722 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1723 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1724 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1725 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1726 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1727 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001728
1729tune.maxpollevents <number>
1730 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1731 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1732 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1733 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1734 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1735
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001736tune.maxrewrite <number>
1737 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1738 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1739 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1740 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1741 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1742 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1743 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1744 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1745 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1746 bufsize.
1747
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001748tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1749 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1750 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1751 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1752 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1753 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1754 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1755 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1756 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1757 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1758 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1759 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1760 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1761 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1762 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1763 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1764 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1765 setting this parameter to 0.
1766
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001767tune.pipesize <number>
1768 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1769 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1770 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1771 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1772 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1773 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1774
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001775tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1776 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1777 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1778 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1779 default is 20.
1780
1781tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1782 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1783 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1784 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1785 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1786 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1787 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
1788 much sense in the general case when targetting connection reuse).
1789
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001790tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1791tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1792 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1793 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1794 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1795 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001796 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001797 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1798 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1799
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001800tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001801 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001802 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1803 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1804 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1805 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1806
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001807tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1808 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1809 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1810 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1811
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001812tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1813tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1814 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1815 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1816 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1817 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001818 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001819 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1820 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1821 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1822 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1823 notifying haproxy again.
1824
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001825tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001826 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1827 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1828 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001829 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001830 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001831 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001832 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1833 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1834 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001835 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1836 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001837
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001838tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001839 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001840 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1841 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1842 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1843 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1844 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1845
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001846tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1847 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001848 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001849 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1850 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1851 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1852 being used for too long.
1853
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001854tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1855 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1856 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1857 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1858 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1859 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1860 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1861 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1862 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1863 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1864 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001865 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001866 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001867
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001868tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1869 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1870 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1871 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1872 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1873 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1874 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1875 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001876 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1877 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001878
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001879tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1880 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1881 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1882 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1883 1000 entries.
1884
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001885tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1886 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1887 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1888 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1889
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001890tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001891tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001892tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1893tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1894tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001895 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1896 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1897 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1898 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1899 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1900 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1901 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1902 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001903
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001904 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1905 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1906 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1907 all available space is consumed.
1908 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1909 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1910 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001911
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001912tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1913 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001914 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001915 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001916 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001917 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1918
1919tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1920 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1921 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001922 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1923 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019253.3. Debugging
1926--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001927
1928debug
1929 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1930 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1931 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1932 system startup.
1933
1934quiet
1935 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1936 line argument "-q".
1937
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001938
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019393.4. Userlists
1940--------------
1941It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1942http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1943it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1944
1945userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001946 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001947 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1948
1949group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001950 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001951 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1952 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1953
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001954user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1955 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001956 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1957 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001958 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1959 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1960 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1961 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001962
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001963 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1964 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1965 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1966 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1967 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1968 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1969 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1970 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1971 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001972
1973 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001974 userlist L1
1975 group G1 users tiger,scott
1976 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001977
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001978 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1979 user scott insecure-password elgato
1980 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001981
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001982 userlist L2
1983 group G1
1984 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001985
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001986 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1987 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1988 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001989
1990 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001991
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001992
19933.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001994----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001995It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1996several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1997instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1998values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1999automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2000In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2001using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2002tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2003reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2004Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2005that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2006each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002007
2008peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002009 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002010 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2011
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002012bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2013 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2014 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2015
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002016disabled
2017 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2018 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2019 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2020
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002021default-bind [param*]
2022 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2023
2024default-server [param*]
2025 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2026
2027 Arguments:
2028 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2029 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2030 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2031 details.
2032
2033
2034 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2035
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002036enable
2037 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2038
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002039peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002040 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2041 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2042 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2043 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2044 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2045 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2046
2047 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2048 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2049
2050 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2051 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2052 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2053 across all peers.
2054
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002055 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2056 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002057
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002058 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2059 "server" keyword explanation below).
2060
2061server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
2062 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
2063 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2064 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2065 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2066 of this "peers" section).
2067 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2068
2069
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002070 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002071 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002072 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002073 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2074 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2075 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002076
2077 backend mybackend
2078 mode tcp
2079 balance roundrobin
2080 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2081 stick on src
2082
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002083 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2084 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002085
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002086 Example:
2087 peers mypeers
2088 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2089 default-server ssl verify none
2090 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2091 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002092
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002093
2094table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2095 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2096
2097 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2098 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
2099 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an aditionnal
2100 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2101 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2102 "stick-table" keyword).
2103
2104 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2105 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2106 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2107 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2108 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2109 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2110 of the stick-table name as follows:
2111
2112 peers mypeers
2113 peer A ...
2114 peer B ...
2115 table t1 ...
2116
2117 frontend fe1
2118 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2119
2120 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2121 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2122
2123 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2124 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2125 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2126 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2127 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2128 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2129 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2130
2131 peers mypeers
2132 peer A ...
2133 peer B ...
2134 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2135
2136 backend t1
2137 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2138
2139 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2140 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2141 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2142
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090021433.6. Mailers
2144------------
2145It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2146If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2147in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2148
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002149mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002150 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2151 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2152
2153mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2154 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2155
2156 Example:
2157 mailers mymailers
2158 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2159 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2160
2161 backend mybackend
2162 mode tcp
2163 balance roundrobin
2164
2165 email-alert mailers mymailers
2166 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2167 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2168
2169 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2170 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2171
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002172timeout mail <time>
2173 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2174 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2175 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2176 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2177
2178 Example:
2179 mailers mymailers
2180 timeout mail 20s
2181 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021834. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002184----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002185
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002186Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002187 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002188 - frontend <name>
2189 - backend <name>
2190 - listen <name>
2191
2192A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2193its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2194section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002195section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002196
2197A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2198connections.
2199
2200A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2201to forward incoming connections.
2202
2203A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2204parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2207'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2208case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2209
2210Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2211logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2212proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2213However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2214name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2215
2216Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2217and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002218bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002219protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2220modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2221arbitrary criteria.
2222
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002223In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2224a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002225the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002226
2227 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2228 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2229 between responses and new requests.
2230
2231 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2232 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2233 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002234 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2235 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2236 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2237 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002238
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002239 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2240 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2241 client-facing connection remains open.
2242
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002243 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2244 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002245
2246The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2247frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2248following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002249weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002250
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002251 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002252
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002253 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2254 ----+-----+-----+----
2255 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2256 ----+-----+-----+----
2257 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2258 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2259 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2260 ----+-----+-----+----
2261 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002262
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002263
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022654.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2266--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002268The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2269limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2270they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2271limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002272marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002273option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002274and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2275with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2276specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002277
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002278
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002279 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2280------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2281acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002282backlog X X X -
2283balance X - X X
2284bind - X X -
2285bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002286block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002287capture cookie - X X -
2288capture request header - X X -
2289capture response header - X X -
2290clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002291compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002292contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2293cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002294declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002295default-server X - X X
2296default_backend X X X -
2297description - X X X
2298disabled X X X X
2299dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002300email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002301email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002302email-alert mailers X X X X
2303email-alert myhostname X X X X
2304email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002305enabled X X X X
2306errorfile X X X X
2307errorloc X X X X
2308errorloc302 X X X X
2309-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2310errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002311force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002312filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002313fullconn X - X X
2314grace X X X X
2315hash-type X - X X
2316http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002317http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002318http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002319http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002320http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002321http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002322http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002323id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002324ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002325load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002326log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002327log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002328log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002329log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002330max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002331maxconn X X X -
2332mode X X X X
2333monitor fail - X X -
2334monitor-net X X X -
2335monitor-uri X X X -
2336option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2337option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2338option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2339option allbackups (*) X - X X
2340option checkcache (*) X - X X
2341option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2342option contstats (*) X X X -
2343option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2344option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002345-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2346option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002347option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002348option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002349option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002350option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002351option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002352option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002353option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002354option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002355option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002356option httpchk X - X X
2357option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002358option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002359option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002360option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002361option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002362option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002363option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2364option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2365option logasap (*) X X X -
2366option mysql-check X - X X
2367option nolinger (*) X X X X
2368option originalto X X X X
2369option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002370option pgsql-check X - X X
2371option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002372option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002373option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002374option smtpchk X - X X
2375option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2376option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2377option splice-request (*) X X X X
2378option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002379option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002380option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2381option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2382-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002383option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002384option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2385option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2386option tcpka X X X X
2387option tcplog X X X X
2388option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002389external-check command X - X X
2390external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002391persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2392rate-limit sessions X X X -
2393redirect - X X X
2394redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2395redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2396reqadd - X X X
2397reqallow - X X X
2398reqdel - X X X
2399reqdeny - X X X
2400reqiallow - X X X
2401reqidel - X X X
2402reqideny - X X X
2403reqipass - X X X
2404reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002405reqitarpit - X X X
2406reqpass - X X X
2407reqrep - X X X
2408-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002409reqtarpit - X X X
2410retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002411retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002412rspadd - X X X
2413rspdel - X X X
2414rspdeny - X X X
2415rspidel - X X X
2416rspideny - X X X
2417rspirep - X X X
2418rsprep - X X X
2419server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002420server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002421server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002422source X - X X
2423srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002424stats admin - X X X
2425stats auth X X X X
2426stats enable X X X X
2427stats hide-version X X X X
2428stats http-request - X X X
2429stats realm X X X X
2430stats refresh X X X X
2431stats scope X X X X
2432stats show-desc X X X X
2433stats show-legends X X X X
2434stats show-node X X X X
2435stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002436-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2437stick match - - X X
2438stick on - - X X
2439stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002440stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002441stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002442tcp-check connect - - X X
2443tcp-check expect - - X X
2444tcp-check send - - X X
2445tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002446tcp-request connection - X X -
2447tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002448tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002449tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002450tcp-response content - - X X
2451tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002452timeout check X - X X
2453timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002454timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002455timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2456timeout connect X - X X
2457timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2458timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2459timeout http-request X X X X
2460timeout queue X - X X
2461timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002462timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002463timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2464timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002465timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002466transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002467unique-id-format X X X -
2468unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002469use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002470use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002471------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2472 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002473
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002474
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024754.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2476---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002477
2478This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2479
2480
2481acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2482 Declare or complete an access list.
2483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2484 no | yes | yes | yes
2485 Example:
2486 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2487 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2488 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002490 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491
2492
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002493backlog <conns>
2494 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2496 yes | yes | yes | no
2497 Arguments :
2498 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2499 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002500 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002501
2502 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2503 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2504 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2505 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2506 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2507 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2508 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2509 backlog parameter.
2510
2511 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2512 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2513 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2514
2515 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2516
2517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002518balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002519balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002520 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2522 yes | no | yes | yes
2523 Arguments :
2524 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2525 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2526 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2527 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2528
2529 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2530 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2531 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2532 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002533 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002534 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002535 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2536 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2537 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2538 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2539 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2540 it, so that you don't worry.
2541
2542 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2543 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2544 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2545 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2546 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2547 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2548 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2549 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002550
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002551 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2552 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2553 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2554 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2555 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2556 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2557 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2558 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2559
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002560 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002561 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002562 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2563 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002564 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002565 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2566 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2567 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2568 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2569 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002570 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2571 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2572 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2573 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2574 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2575 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002577 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2578 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2579 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2580 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2581 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2582 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2583 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2584 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002585 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002586 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002587 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2588 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2589 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002590
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002591 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2592 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2593 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2594 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2595 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2596 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2597 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2598 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2599 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2600 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2601 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2602 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002604 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002605 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2606 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2607 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2608 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2609 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2610 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2611 URIs start with a leading "/".
2612
2613 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2614 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2615 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2616 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002619 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2620
2621 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002622 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2623 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002624 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2625 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2626 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2627 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002628 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002629 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2630 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002631
2632 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2633 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2634 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2635 server will receive the request.
2636
2637 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2638 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2639 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2640 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2641 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002642 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2643 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2644 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002645
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002646 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2647 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2648 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2649 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2650 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002651
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002652 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002653 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2654 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2655 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2656
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002657 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2658 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2659 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2660
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002661 random
2662 random(<draws>)
2663 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002664 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2665 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2666 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2667 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002668 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2669 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2670 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2671 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2672 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2673 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2674 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2675 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2676 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2677 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2678 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2679 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2680 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2681 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2682 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2683 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2684 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2685 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2686 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2687 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002688
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002689 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002690 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002691 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2692 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2693 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2694 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2695 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2696 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002697 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002698 used instead.
2699
2700 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2701 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2702 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2703 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2704
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002705 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2706 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2707 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2708
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002709 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002710
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002711 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002712 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2713 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002714
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002715 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2716 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2717 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002718
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002719 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2720 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2721 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2722 NTLM relies on.
2723
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002724 Examples :
2725 balance roundrobin
2726 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002727 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002728 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2729 balance hdr(host)
2730 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002731
2732 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2733 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002735 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002736 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2737 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2738 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2739 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2740
2741 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2742 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2743 defaults to 16 kB.
2744
2745 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2746 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2747
2748 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2749 Round Robin.
2750
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002751 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002752 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2753 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2754 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2755
2756 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2757
2758 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002759 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002760 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2761 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2762 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002763
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002764 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002765
2766
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002767bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2768bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002769 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2771 no | yes | yes | no
2772 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002773 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2774 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2775 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2776 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002777 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002778 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2779 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2780 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2781 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2782 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2783 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2784 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002785 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2786 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2787 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2788 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2789 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2790 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2791 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002792 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2793 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2794 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002795 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2796 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2797 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2798 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002799 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2800 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2801 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002802
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002803 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2804 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002805 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2806 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2807 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002808 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2809 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2810 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2811 the range.
2812
2813 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2814 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2815 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2816 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2817 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2818 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2819 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002820 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002821 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002822
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002823 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002824 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002825 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2826 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2827 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2828 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2829 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2830 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2831
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002832 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2833 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2834 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2835 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002836
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002837 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2838 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2839 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2840 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2841 in a frontend.
2842
2843 Example :
2844 listen http_proxy
2845 bind :80,:443
2846 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002847 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002848
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002849 listen http_https_proxy
2850 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002851 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002852
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002853 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2854 bind ipv6@:80
2855 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2856 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2857
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002858 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002859 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002860
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002861 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2862 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2863 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2864 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2865 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2866
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002867 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002868 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002869
2870
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002871bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002872 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2874 yes | yes | yes | yes
2875 Arguments :
2876 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2877 may be used to override a default value.
2878
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002879 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002880 option may be combined with other numbers.
2881
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002882 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002883 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2884 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2885 missing from all processes.
2886
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002887 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002888 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002889 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2890 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2891 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2892 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2893 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002894 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002895
2896 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2897 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2898 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2899 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2900 and 'even' instances.
2901
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002902 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2903 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2904 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2905 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002906
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002907 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2908 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2909
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002910 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2911 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2912 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2913
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002914 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2915 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2916
2917 Example :
2918 listen app_ip1
2919 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002920 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002921
2922 listen app_ip2
2923 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002924 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002925
2926 listen management
2927 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002928 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002929
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002930 listen management
2931 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2932 bind-process 1-4
2933
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002934 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002935
2936
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002937block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002938 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2940 no | yes | yes | yes
2941
2942 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2943 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002944 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002945 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002946 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002947 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2948 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2949 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002950
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002951 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2952 "http-request deny" instead.
2953
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 Example:
2955 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2956 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2957 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002958 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2959 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2960 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002961
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002962 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2963 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2964 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002965
2966capture cookie <name> len <length>
2967 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2969 no | yes | yes | no
2970 Arguments :
2971 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2972 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2973 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2974 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002975 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002976
2977 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2978 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2979 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2980 right if it exceeds <length>.
2981
2982 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2983 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2984 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2985 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2986
2987 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2988 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2989 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2990
2991 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2992 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2993 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002994 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2995 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2996 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002997
2998 Example:
2999 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3000
3001 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003002 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003003
3004
3005capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003006 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3008 no | yes | yes | no
3009 Arguments :
3010 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003011 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003012 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3013 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3014 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3015
3016 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3017 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3018 it exceeds <length>.
3019
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003020 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003021 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3022 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003023 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3024 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3025 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3026 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003027 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003028 environments to find where the request came from.
3029
3030 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3031 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3032 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3033 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003034
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003035 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3036 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3037 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3038 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3039 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040
3041 Example:
3042 capture request header Host len 15
3043 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003044 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003046 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003047 about logging.
3048
3049
3050capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003051 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3053 no | yes | yes | no
3054 Arguments :
3055 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003056 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003057 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3058 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3059 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3060
3061 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3062 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3063 it exceeds <length>.
3064
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003065 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003066 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3067 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3068 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003069 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3070 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3071 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3072 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003073
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003074 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3075 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3076 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3077 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3078 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003079
3080 Example:
3081 capture response header Content-length len 9
3082 capture response header Location len 15
3083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003084 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003085 about logging.
3086
3087
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003088clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003089 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3091 yes | yes | yes | no
3092 Arguments :
3093 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3094 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3095 as explained at the top of this document.
3096
3097 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3098 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3099 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3100 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3101 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3102 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3103 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3104 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003105 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003106 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003107 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003108
3109 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3110 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3111 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3112 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3113 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3114 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3115
3116 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3117 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3118
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003119 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3120 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003121
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003122compression algo <algorithm> ...
3123compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003124compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003125 Enable HTTP compression.
3126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3127 yes | yes | yes | yes
3128 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003129 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3130 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3131 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3132
3133 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003134 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3135 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3136 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003137
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003138 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003139 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003140
3141 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3142 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3143 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3144 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3145 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003146 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003147
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003148 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3149 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3150 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3151 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3152 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3153 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3154 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003155 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003156
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003157 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003158 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003159 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3160 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3161 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3162 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3163 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003164
3165 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3166 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3167 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3168 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3169 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003170 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3171 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3172 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3173 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3174 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003175 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3176 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003177
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003178 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003179 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3180 "Accept-Encoding" header
3181 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003182 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003183 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3184 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3185 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3186 "multipart"
3187 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3188 header
3189 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3190 and later
3191 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3192 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003193 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003194
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003195 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003196
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003197 Examples :
3198 compression algo gzip
3199 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003200
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003201
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003202contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003203 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3205 yes | no | yes | yes
3206 Arguments :
3207 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3208 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3209 as explained at the top of this document.
3210
3211 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003212 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003213 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003214 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003215 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3216 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3217 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3218
3219 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3220 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3221 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3222 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3223 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3224 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3225
3226 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3227 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3228 instead.
3229
3230 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3231 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3232
3233
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003234cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003235 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3236 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003237 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3240 yes | no | yes | yes
3241 Arguments :
3242 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3243 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3244 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3245 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3246 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3247 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003248 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003249 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3250 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3251
3252 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3253 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3254 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3255 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3256 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3257 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003258 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3259 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003260 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003261 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3262 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003263
3264 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003265 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003266
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003267 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003268 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3269 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003270 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003271 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3272 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3273 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3274 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3275 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3276 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3277 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003278
3279 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3280 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3281 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3282 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3283 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3284 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3285 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3286 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3287 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003288 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003289 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3290 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3291 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003292
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003293 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3294 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3295 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003296 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3297 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3298 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3299 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003300 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3301 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3302 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003303
3304 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3305 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3306 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3307 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3308 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3309 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3310 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3311 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3312 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3313
3314 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3315 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3316 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3317 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3318 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3319 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3320 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3321 persistence cookie in the cache.
3322 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3323
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003324 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3325 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3326 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3327 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3328 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003329 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003330 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3331 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3332 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3333 they logout.
3334
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003335 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3336 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3337 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3338 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3339
3340 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3341 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3342 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3343 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3344 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3345 this attribute.
3346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003347 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003348 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003349 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3350 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3351 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3352 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3353 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3354 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003355
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003356 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3357 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3358 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3359 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3360 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3361 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3362 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3363 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003364 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003365 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3366 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3367 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3368 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3369 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3370 the site.
3371
3372 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3373 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3374 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3375 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3376 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3377 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3378 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3379 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3380 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3381 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3382 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3383 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3384 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003385 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003386 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3387 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3388
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003389 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3390 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3391 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3392 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3393 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3394 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003396 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3397 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3398 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3399 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003401 Examples :
3402 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3403 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3404 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003405 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003406
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003407 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003408
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003409
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003410declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3411 Declares a capture slot.
3412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3413 no | yes | yes | no
3414 Arguments:
3415 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3416
3417 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3418 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3419 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3420 for use in the response.
3421
3422 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003423 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003424 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3425
3426
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003427default-server [param*]
3428 Change default options for a server in a backend
3429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3430 yes | no | yes | yes
3431 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003432 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3433 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3434 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3435 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003436
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003437 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003438 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3439
3440 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003441
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003442
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003443default_backend <backend>
3444 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3446 yes | yes | yes | no
3447 Arguments :
3448 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3449
3450 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3451 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3452 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3453 will catch all undetermined requests.
3454
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003455 Example :
3456
3457 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3458 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3459 default_backend dynamic
3460
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003461 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003464description <string>
3465 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3467 no | yes | yes | yes
3468 Arguments : string
3469
3470 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3471 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3472 it describes.
3473 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3474
3475
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476disabled
3477 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3479 yes | yes | yes | yes
3480 Arguments : none
3481
3482 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3483 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3484 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3485 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3486 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3487 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3488 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3489
3490 See also : "enabled"
3491
3492
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003493dispatch <address>:<port>
3494 Set a default server address
3495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3496 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003497 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003498
3499 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3500 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3501 during start-up.
3502
3503 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3504 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3505 possible with normal servers.
3506
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003507 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003508 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3509 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3510 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3511 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3512
3513 See also : "server"
3514
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003515
3516dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3517 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3519 yes | no | yes | yes
3520 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3521
3522 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003523 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003524 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3525 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003526 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003527 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003529enabled
3530 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3532 yes | yes | yes | yes
3533 Arguments : none
3534
3535 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3536 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3537
3538 See also : "disabled"
3539
3540
3541errorfile <code> <file>
3542 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3544 yes | yes | yes | yes
3545 Arguments :
3546 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003547 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3548 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003549
3550 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003551 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003552 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003553 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3554 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003555
3556 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3557 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3558 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3559
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003560 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003562 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3563 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3564 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3565 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3566
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003567 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3568 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003569 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003570 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3571 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3572 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3575 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3576 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003577 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003578 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3579
3580 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3581
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003582 Example :
3583 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003584 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003585 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3586 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3587
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003588
3589errorloc <code> <url>
3590errorloc302 <code> <url>
3591 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3593 yes | yes | yes | yes
3594 Arguments :
3595 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003596 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3597 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003598
3599 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3600 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3601 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3602 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003603 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003604
3605 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3606 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3607 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3608
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003609 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3610
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003611 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3612 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3613 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3614 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003615 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003616 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3617 request.
3618
3619 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3620
3621
3622errorloc303 <code> <url>
3623 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3625 yes | yes | yes | yes
3626 Arguments :
3627 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003628 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3629 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003630
3631 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3632 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3633 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3634 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003635 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003636
3637 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3638 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3639 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3640
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003641 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3642
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003643 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3644 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3645 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3646 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003647 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003648
3649 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3650
3651
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003652email-alert from <emailaddr>
3653 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003654 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003655 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3656 yes | yes | yes | yes
3657
3658 Arguments :
3659
3660 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3661
3662 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3663 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3664
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003665 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003666 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3667 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003668
3669
3670email-alert level <level>
3671 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3672 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3673 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3674 yes | yes | yes | yes
3675
3676 Arguments :
3677
3678 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3679 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3680 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3681
3682 By default level is alert
3683
3684 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3685 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3686 for the proxy.
3687
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003688 Alerts are sent when :
3689
3690 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3691 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3692 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3693 is notice or lower
3694 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3695 and a health check status update occurs
3696
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003697 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3698 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003699 section 3.6 about mailers.
3700
3701
3702email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3703 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3704 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3705 yes | yes | yes | yes
3706
3707 Arguments :
3708
3709 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3710
3711 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3712 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3713
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003714 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3715 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003716
3717
3718email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3719 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3720 mailers.
3721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3722 yes | yes | yes | yes
3723
3724 Arguments :
3725
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003726 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003727
3728 By default the systems hostname is used.
3729
3730 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3731 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3732 for the proxy.
3733
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003734 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3735 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003736
3737
3738email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003739 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003740 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3741 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3742 yes | yes | yes | yes
3743
3744 Arguments :
3745
3746 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3747
3748 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3749 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3750
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003751 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003752 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3753
3754
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003755force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3756 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3757 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003758 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003759
3760 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3761 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3762 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3763 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3764 marked down for maintenance operations.
3765
3766 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3767 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3768 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3769 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3770 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3771 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3772 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3773 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3774 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3775
3776 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3777 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3778 is used.
3779
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003780 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003781 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003782
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003783
3784filter <name> [param*]
3785 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3787 no | yes | yes | yes
3788 Arguments :
3789 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3790 referenced in section 9.
3791
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003792 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003793 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003794 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3795 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003796
3797 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3798 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3799
3800 Example:
3801 listen
3802 bind *:80
3803
3804 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3805 filter compression
3806 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3807
3808 compression algo gzip
3809 compression offload
3810
3811 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3812
3813 See also : section 9.
3814
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003815
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003816fullconn <conns>
3817 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3819 yes | no | yes | yes
3820 Arguments :
3821 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3822 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3823
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003824 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003825 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003826 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003827 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3828 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3829 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3830 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3831 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003832 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003833
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003834 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3835 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003836 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3837 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3838 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003839
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003840 Example :
3841 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3842 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3843 # connections.
3844 backend dynamic
3845 fullconn 10000
3846 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3847 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3848
3849 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3850
3851
3852grace <time>
3853 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003855 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003856 Arguments :
3857 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3858 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3859 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3860
3861 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3862 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003863 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003864 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3865
3866 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3867 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3868 simplify it.
3869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003870
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003871hash-balance-factor <factor>
3872 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3874 yes | no | no | yes
3875 Arguments :
3876 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3877 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003878 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003879
3880 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3881 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3882 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3883 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3884 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3885 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3886 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3887
3888 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3889 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3890 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3891 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3892 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3893
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003894 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3895 consistent hashing mechanism.
3896
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003897 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3898
3899
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003900hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003901 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3903 yes | no | yes | yes
3904 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003905 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3906 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003907
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003908 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3909 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3910 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3911 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3912 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3913 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3914 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3915 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3916 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3917 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003918
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003919 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3920 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3921 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3922 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3923 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3924 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3925 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3926 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3927 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3928 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3929 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3930 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3931 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003932 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3933 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003934
3935 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3936
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003937 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003938 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3939 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3940 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003941 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3942 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3943 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003944
3945 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3946 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003947 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3948 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3949 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3950 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3951
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003952 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3953 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3954 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3955 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3956 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3957 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3958 parameter.
3959
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003960 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3961 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3962 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3963 used on strings.
3964
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003965 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3966
3967 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3968 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3969 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3970 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3971 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3972 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3973 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3974 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3975 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3976 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3977 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3978 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003979
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003980 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3981 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3982 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003983
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003984 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003985
3986
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003987http-check disable-on-404
3988 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003990 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003991 Arguments : none
3992
3993 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3994 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3995 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3996 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3997 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3998 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3999 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4000 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004001 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4002 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4003 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4004
4005 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4006
4007
4008http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004009 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004011 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004012 Arguments :
4013 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4014 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004015 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004016 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4017 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4018 details on the supported keywords.
4019
4020 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4021 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4022 with the usual backslash ('\').
4023
4024 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4025 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4026 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4027 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4028 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4029
4030 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004031 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004032 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4033 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4034 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4035
4036 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004037 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004038 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4039 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4040 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4041 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4042
4043 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004044 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004045 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4046 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4047 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4048 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4049 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004050 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004051 trace).
4052
4053 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004054 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004055 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4056 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4057 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4058 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4059 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004060 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004061
4062 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4063 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4064 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4065 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4066 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4067 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4068 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4069 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4070
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004071 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4072 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4073 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4074
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004075 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4076 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4077
4078 Examples :
4079 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004080 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004081
4082 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004083 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004084
4085 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004086 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004087
4088 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004089 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004091 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004092
4093
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004094http-check send-state
4095 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4097 yes | no | yes | yes
4098 Arguments : none
4099
4100 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4101 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4102 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4103 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4104 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4105
4106 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4107 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4108 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4109 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4110 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004111 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4112 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4113 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4114
4115 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4116 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4117 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4118
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004119 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4120 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4121 checked in multiple backends.
4122
4123 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4124 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4125
4126 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4127 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4128 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4129 one fails.
4130
4131 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4132 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4133 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4134
4135 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4136 server's queue.
4137
4138 Example of a header received by the application server :
4139 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4140 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4141
4142 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4143
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004144
4145http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004146 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4147
4148 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4149 no | yes | yes | yes
4150
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004151 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4152 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4153 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4154 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4155 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004157 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4158 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004160 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004162 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4163 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4164 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4165 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004167 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4168 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4169 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4170 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004172 Example:
4173 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4174 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4175 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004176
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004177 http-request allow if nagios
4178 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4179 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4180 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004182 Example:
4183 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4184 acl add path /addacl
4185 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004187 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004189 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4190 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004192 Example:
4193 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4194 acl setmap path /setmap
4195 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004196
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004197 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004198
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004199 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4200 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004201
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004202 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4203 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004205http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004206
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004207 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4208 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4209 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4210 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4211 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4212 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4213 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4214 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004216http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004217
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004218 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4219 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4220 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4221 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4222 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4223 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4224 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4225 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004226
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004227http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004228
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004229 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4230 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004231
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004233http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004235 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4236 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4237 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4238 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4239 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004241 Example:
4242 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4243 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004244
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004245http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004247 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004249http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4250 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004252 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4253 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4254 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4255 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4256 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4257 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4258 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4259 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4260 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004262 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4263 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4264 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4265 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4266 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4267 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004268
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004269http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004270
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004271 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4272 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4273 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4274 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4275 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4276 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004280 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4285 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4286 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4287 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4288 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4289 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004291http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004293 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4294 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4295 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4296 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4297 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004298
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004299http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4300 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4301 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4302 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4303
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004304http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4305
4306 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4307 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4308 pointed by <resolvers>.
4309 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4310 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4311 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4312 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4313 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4314 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4315 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4316 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4317 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4318 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4319 to 0.0.0.0.
4320
4321 Example:
4322 resolvers mydns
4323 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4324 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4325 timeout retry 1s
4326 hold valid 10s
4327 hold nx 3s
4328 hold other 3s
4329 hold obsolete 0s
4330 accepted_payload_size 8192
4331
4332 frontend fe
4333 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4334 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4335 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4336
4337 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4338 # which mean DNS resolution error
4339 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4340
4341 default_backend be
4342
4343 backend b_503
4344 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4345 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4346 # 503 error page to end users
4347
4348 backend be
4349 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4350 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4351 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4352 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4353 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4354
4355 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4356 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4357
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004358http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4359
4360 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4361 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4362 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4363 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004364 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4365 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004366
4367 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004371 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4372 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4373 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4374 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4375 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004377http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004378
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004379 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4380 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4381 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4382 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4385 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004387 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4388 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4389 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4390 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4391 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4392 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4393 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4394 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396 Example:
4397 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004398
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004399 # applied to:
4400 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004402 # outputs:
4403 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004405 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004407http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4408 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004410 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4411 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4412 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4413 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004415 Example:
4416 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004418 # applied to:
4419 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004420
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004421 # outputs:
4422 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004424http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4425http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004427 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4428 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4429 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004431http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004433 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4434 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4435 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004436
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004437http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004439 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4440 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4441 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4442 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4443 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004444
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004445 Arguments:
4446 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4447 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004448
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004449 Example:
4450 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4451 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004452
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004453 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4454 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004455
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004456http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004457
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004458 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4459 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4460 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004462 Arguments:
4463 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4464 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004465
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004466 Example:
4467 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4468 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004470 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4471 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4472 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004473
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004474http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004475
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004476 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4477 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4478 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4479 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4480 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004482 Example:
4483 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4484 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4485 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4486 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4487 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4488 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4489 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4490 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4491 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004493http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004495 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4496 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4497 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4498 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4499 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004500
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004501http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4502 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004504 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4505 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4506 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4507 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4508 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4509 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4510 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4511 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4512 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004514http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004515
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004516 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4517 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4518 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4519 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4520 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4521 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4522 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004523
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004524http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004526 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4527 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4528 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004530http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004531
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004532 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4533 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4534 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4535 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4536 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4537 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4538 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4539 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004540
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004541http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004542
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004543 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4544 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4545 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4546 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4547 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4548 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004549
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004550 Example :
4551 # prepend the host name before the path
4552 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004553
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004554http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004556 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4557 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4558 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4559 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4560 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004562http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004563
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004564 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4565 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4566 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4567 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4568 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4569 values have higher priority.
4570 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4571 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4572 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4573 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4574 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004576http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004577
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004578 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4579 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4580 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4581 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4582 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4583 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4584 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004586 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004587
4588 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004589 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4590 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004592http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4593 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4594 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4595 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4596 privacy.
4597
4598 Arguments :
4599 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4600 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004601
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004602 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004603 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4604 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4605
4606 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4607 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4608
4609http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4610
4611 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4612 expression.
4613
4614 Arguments:
4615 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4616 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004617
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004618 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4620 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4621
4622 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4623 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4624 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4625
4626http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4627
4628 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4629 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4630 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4631 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4632 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4633 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4634 information from the request.
4635
4636 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4637
4638http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4639
4640 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4641 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4642 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4643 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4644 path and the query string.
4645 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4646
4647http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4648
4649 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4650 inline.
4651
4652 Arguments:
4653 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4654 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4655 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4656 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4657 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4658 (request and response)
4659 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4660 processing
4661 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4662 processing
4663 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4664 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4665 and '_'.
4666
4667 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4668 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004669
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004670 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004671 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004673http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4674 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004676 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4677 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4678 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4679 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4680 agent name must be used.
4681
4682 Arguments:
4683 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4684
4685 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4686 configuration.
4687
4688http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4689
4690 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4691 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4692 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4693 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4694 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4695 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4696 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4697 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4698 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4699 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4700 action.
4701 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4702 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4703 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4704 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4705 you fully understand how it works.
4706
4707http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4708
4709 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4710 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4711 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4712 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4713 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4714 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4715 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4716 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4717 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4718 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4719 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4720 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4721 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4722
4723http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4724http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4725http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4726
4727 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4728 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4729 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4730 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4731 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4732 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4733 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4734 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4735 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4736 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4737 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4738 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4739
4740 Arguments :
4741 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4742 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4743 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4744 select which table entry to update the counters.
4745
4746 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4747 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4748 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4749 that table until the session ends.
4750
4751 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4752 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4753 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4754 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4755 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4756 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4757 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4758 useful information.
4759
4760 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4761 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4762 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4763 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4764 checks that make use of it.
4765
4766http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4767
4768 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004769
4770 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004771 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004772
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004773http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004774
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004775 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4776 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4777 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004778
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004779
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004780http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004781 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4782
4783 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4784 no | yes | yes | yes
4785
4786 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4787 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4788 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4789 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4790 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4791 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4792
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004793 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4794 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004795
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004796 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004797
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004798 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4799 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4800 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4801 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004802
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004803 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4804 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4805 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4806 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004807
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004808 Example:
4809 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004810
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004811 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004812
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004813 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4814 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004815
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004816 Example:
4817 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004818
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004819 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004820
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004821 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4822 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004823
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004824 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4825 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004827http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004828
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004829 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4830 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4831 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4832 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4833 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4834 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4835 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4836 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004837
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004838http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004840 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4841 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4842 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4843 example, or to pass some internal information.
4844 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4845 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4846 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004847
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004848http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004849
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004850 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4851 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004852
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004853http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004854
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004855 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004856
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004857http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004858
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004859 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4860 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4861 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4862 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4863 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4864 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4865 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004866
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004867 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4868 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4869 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4870 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4871 keyword.
4872 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4873 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004874
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004875http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004876
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004877 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4878 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4879 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4880 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4881 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4882 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004883
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004884http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004885
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004886 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004887
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004888http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004889
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004890 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4891 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4892 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4893 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4894 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4895 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004896
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004897http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004898
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004899 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4900 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004901
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004902http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004903
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004904 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4905 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4906 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4907 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4908 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4909 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004910
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004911http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4912 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004913
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004914 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4915 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4916 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4917 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4918 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4919 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4920 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4921 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004922
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004923 Example:
4924 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004925
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004926 # applied to:
4927 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004928
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004929 # outputs:
4930 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004931
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004932 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004933
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004934http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4935 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004937 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4938 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4939 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4940 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004942 Example:
4943 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004944
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004945 # applied to:
4946 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004947
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004948 # outputs:
4949 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004950
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004951http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4952http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004954 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4955 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4956 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004958http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004960 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4961 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4962 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004964http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004965
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004966 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4967 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4968 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4969 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4970 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004972 Arguments:
4973 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004974
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004975 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4976 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004978http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004980 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4981 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4982 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004984http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4985
4986 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4987 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4988 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4989 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4990 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4991
4992http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4993
4994 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4995 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4996 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4997 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4998 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4999 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5000 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5001 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5002 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5003
5004http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5005
5006 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5007 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5008 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5009 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5010 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5011 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5012 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5013
5014http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5015
5016 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5017 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5018 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5019 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5020 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5021 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5022 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5023 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5024
5025http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5026 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5027
5028 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5029 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5030 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5031 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005032
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005033 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005034 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5035 http-response set-status 431
5036 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5037 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005039http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5042 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5043 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5044 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5045 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5046 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5047 based on some information from the request.
5048
5049 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5050
5051http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5052
5053 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5054 inline.
5055
5056 Arguments:
5057 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5058 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5059 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5060 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5061 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5062 (request and response)
5063 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5064 processing
5065 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5066 processing
5067 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5068 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5069 and '_'.
5070
5071 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5072 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005073
5074 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005075 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005076
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005077http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005078
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005079 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5080 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5081 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5082 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5083 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5084 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5085 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5086 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5087 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5088 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5089 action.
5090 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5091 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5092 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5093 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5094 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005096http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5097http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5098http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005099
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005100 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5101 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5102 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5103 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5104 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5105 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5106
5107http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5108
5109 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5110 about <var-name>.
5111
5112 Example:
5113 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5114
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005115
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005116http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5117 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5118
5119 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5120 yes | no | yes | yes
5121
5122 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005123 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5124 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5125 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005126
5127 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5128
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005129 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5130 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5131 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5132 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5133 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5134 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5135 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5136 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5137 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5138 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005139
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005140 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5141 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5142 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5143 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5144 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5145 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5146 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5147 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005148
5149 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5150 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5151 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5152 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5153 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5154 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5155 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5156 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5157 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5158 downsides of rare connection failures.
5159
5160 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5161 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5162 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5163 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5164 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5165 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005166 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005167 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5168 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5169 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5170 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5171 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5172
5173 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005174 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5175 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5176 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005177
5178 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005179 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005180
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005181 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5182 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005183
5184 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5185 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5186 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5187
5188 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5189 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5190 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5191
5192 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5193
5194
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005195http-send-name-header [<header>]
5196 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5197
5198 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5199 yes | no | yes | yes
5200
5201 Arguments :
5202
5203 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5204
5205 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005206 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005207 is added with the header string proved.
5208
5209 See also : "server"
5210
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005211id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005212 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5214 no | yes | yes | yes
5215 Arguments : none
5216
5217 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5218 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5219 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005220
5221
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005222ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5223 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5224 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005225 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005226
5227 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5228 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5229 and running).
5230
5231 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5232 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5233 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005234 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005235 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5236
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005237 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5238 "unless" condition is met.
5239
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005240 Example:
5241 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5242 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5243 ignore-persist if url_static
5244
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005245 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5246
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005247load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5248 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5249 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5250 yes | no | yes | yes
5251
5252 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5253 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5254 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005255 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005256 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5257 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5258 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5259 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5260
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005261 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005262 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005263 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005264
5265 Arguments:
5266 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5267 named "server-state-file".
5268
5269 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5270 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5271 name is used as a file name.
5272
5273 none don't load any stat for this backend
5274
5275 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005276 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5277 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5278 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005279 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005280 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005281
5282 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5283 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5284
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005285 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005286
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005287 global
5288 stats socket /tmp/socket
5289 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005290
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005291 defaults
5292 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005293
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005294 backend bk
5295 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5296 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005297
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005298
5299 Then one can run :
5300
5301 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5302
5303 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5304
5305 1
5306 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5307 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5308 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5309
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005310 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005311
5312 global
5313 stats socket /tmp/socket
5314 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5315
5316 defaults
5317 load-server-state-from-file local
5318
5319 backend bk
5320 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5321 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5322
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005323
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005324 Then one can run :
5325
5326 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5327
5328 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5329
5330 1
5331 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5332 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5333 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5334
5335 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5336 "show servers state"
5337
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005338
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005339log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005340log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5341 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005342no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005343 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5345 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005346
5347 Prefix :
5348 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5349 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5350 prefix does not allow arguments.
5351
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005352 Arguments :
5353 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5354 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5355 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5356 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5357 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5358 parameter.
5359
5360 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5361 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5362
5363 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5364 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5365 standard syslog port).
5366
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005367 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5368 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5369 standard syslog port).
5370
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005371 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5372 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5373 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005374 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005375
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005376 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5377 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5378 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5379 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5380 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5381 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5382 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5383 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5384 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5385 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5386 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5387 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5388 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5389 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5390 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5391 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005392 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5393 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005394
5395 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5396 and "fd@2", see above.
5397
5398 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5399 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005400
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005401 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5402 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5403 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5404 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5405 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5406 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5407 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5408 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5409 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5410 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005411 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005412
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005413 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5414 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5415 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5416 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5417 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5418
5419 <sample_size>
5420 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5421 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5422 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5423 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5424 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5425
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005426 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5427 one of the following :
5428
5429 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5430 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5431
5432 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5433 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5434
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005435 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5436 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5437 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5438 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5439 systemd logger consumes.
5440
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005441 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5442 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5443 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5444 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5445
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005446 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5447
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005448 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5449 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5450 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5451
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005452 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5453 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5454 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5455 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005456
5457 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5458 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5459 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005460 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5461 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5462 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5463 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5464 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005465
5466 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5467
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005468 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5469 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5470 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005471
5472 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5473 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5474 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5475 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5476
5477 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5478 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005479
5480 Example :
5481 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005482 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5483 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5484 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005485 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5486 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005487 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005488
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005489
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005490log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005491 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5492 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5493 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005494
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005495 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5496 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5497 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5498 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5499 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005500
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005501 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5502 "option httplog" directives.
5503
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005504log-format-sd <string>
5505 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5506 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5507 yes | yes | yes | no
5508
5509 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5510 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5511 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5512 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5513 which covers the log format string in depth.
5514
5515 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5516 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5517
5518 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5519 log format to "rfc5424".
5520
5521 Example :
5522 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5523
5524
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005525log-tag <string>
5526 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5527 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5528 yes | yes | yes | yes
5529
5530 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5531 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5532 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5533 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5534 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5535 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5536 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5537 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5538 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005539
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005540max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5541 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5542 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5543 yes | no | yes | yes
5544
5545 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5546 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5547 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5548 servers.
5549
5550 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5551 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5552 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5553 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5554 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005555 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005556 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5557 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5558 picking a different server.
5559
5560 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5561 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5562 even if they have to be queued.
5563
5564 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5565 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5566
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005567max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5568 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5569 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5570 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005571
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005572maxconn <conns>
5573 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5575 yes | yes | yes | no
5576 Arguments :
5577 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5578 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5579 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5580 closes.
5581
5582 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5583 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5584 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5585 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005586 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5587 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5588 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5589 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005590
5591 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5592 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5593 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5594
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005595 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5596 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005597
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005598 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5599
5600
5601mode { tcp|http|health }
5602 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5604 yes | yes | yes | yes
5605 Arguments :
5606 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5607 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5608 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5609 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5610
5611 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5612 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5613 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5614 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5615 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5616
5617 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005618 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5619 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5620 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5621 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5622 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5623 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5624 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005625
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005626 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5627 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5628 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005629
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005630 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005631 defaults http_instances
5632 mode http
5633
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005634 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005635
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005636
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005637monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005638 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5640 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005641 Arguments :
5642 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5643 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005644 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005645 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5646 backend and its backup.
5647
5648 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5649 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5650 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5651 servers in a list of backends.
5652
5653 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5654 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5655 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5656 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5657 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5658 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5659 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005660 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5661 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005662
5663 Example:
5664 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005665 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005666 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5667 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5668 monitor-uri /site_alive
5669 monitor fail if site_dead
5670
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005671 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005672
5673
5674monitor-net <source>
5675 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5677 yes | yes | yes | no
5678 Arguments :
5679 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5680 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5681 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5682 followed by a mask.
5683
5684 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5685 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005686 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005687 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5688
5689 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5690 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5691 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5692 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005693 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5694 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5695 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005696
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005697 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5698 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5699 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5700 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5701 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5702 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005703
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005704 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5705 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005706
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005707 Example :
5708 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5709 frontend www
5710 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5711
5712 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5713
5714
5715monitor-uri <uri>
5716 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5718 yes | yes | yes | no
5719 Arguments :
5720 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5721 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5722
5723 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5724 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5725 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5726 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5727 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5728 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5729 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5730 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5731
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005732 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5733 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5734 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5735 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5736 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5737 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5738 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5739 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005740
5741 Example :
5742 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5743 frontend www
5744 mode http
5745 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5746
5747 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5748
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005749
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005750option abortonclose
5751no option abortonclose
5752 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5754 yes | no | yes | yes
5755 Arguments : none
5756
5757 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5758 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5759 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5760 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005761 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005762 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5763 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5764 encountered while delivering the response.
5765
5766 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5767 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5768 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5769 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5770 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5771 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005772 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005773 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005774 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005775 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5776 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5777 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5778
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005779 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5780 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005781 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5782 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5783 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5784 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5785 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5786 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005787 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005788
5789 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5790 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5791
5792 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5793
5794
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005795option accept-invalid-http-request
5796no option accept-invalid-http-request
5797 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5799 yes | yes | yes | no
5800 Arguments : none
5801
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005802 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005803 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005804 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005805 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5806 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5807 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5808 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5809 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005810 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5811 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5812 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5813 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005814 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005815 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005816 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5817 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5818 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005819
5820 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5821 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5822 been confirmed.
5823
5824 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5825 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005826 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5827 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005828 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5829
5830 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5831 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5832
5833 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5834 stats socket.
5835
5836
5837option accept-invalid-http-response
5838no option accept-invalid-http-response
5839 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5841 yes | no | yes | yes
5842 Arguments : none
5843
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005844 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005845 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005846 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005847 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5848 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5849 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5850 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5851 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005852 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5853 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5854 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005855
5856 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5857 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5858 been confirmed.
5859
5860 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5861 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5862 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5863 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5864
5865 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5866 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5867
5868 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5869 stats socket.
5870
5871
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005872option allbackups
5873no option allbackups
5874 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5876 yes | no | yes | yes
5877 Arguments : none
5878
5879 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5880 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5881 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5882 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5883 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5884 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5885 order between the backup servers anymore.
5886
5887 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5888 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5889
5890 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5891 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5892
5893
5894option checkcache
5895no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005896 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5898 yes | no | yes | yes
5899 Arguments : none
5900
5901 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5902 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005903 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005904 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5905 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005906 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005907
5908 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005909 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005910 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005911 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5912 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005913 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005914 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005915 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5916 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005917 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005918 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5919 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005920 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005921 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5922 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5923 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5924 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5925 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5926 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5927 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5928 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5929 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5930
5931 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005932 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005933 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005934 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005935 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5936
5937 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5938 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005939 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005940 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005941
5942 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5943 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5944
5945
5946option clitcpka
5947no option clitcpka
5948 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5950 yes | yes | yes | no
5951 Arguments : none
5952
5953 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5954 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005955 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005956 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5957
5958 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5959 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5960 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5961 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5962
5963 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5964 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5965 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5966 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5967 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5968
5969 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5970
5971 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5972 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5973 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5974
5975 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5976 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5977
5978 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5979
5980
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005981option contstats
5982 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5984 yes | yes | yes | no
5985 Arguments : none
5986
5987 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5988 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5989 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5990 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005991 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5992 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5993 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5994 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5995 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005996
5997
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005998option dontlog-normal
5999no option dontlog-normal
6000 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6002 yes | yes | yes | no
6003 Arguments : none
6004
6005 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6006 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6007 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6008 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6009 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6010 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6011 logged.
6012
6013 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6014 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6015 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006017 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006018 logging.
6019
6020
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006021option dontlognull
6022no option dontlognull
6023 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6025 yes | yes | yes | no
6026 Arguments : none
6027
6028 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6029 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6030 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6031 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6032 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6033 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006034 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6035 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6036 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006037
6038 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006039 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006040 would not be logged.
6041
6042 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6043 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6044
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006045 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6046 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006047
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006048
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006049option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006050 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6052 yes | yes | yes | yes
6053 Arguments :
6054 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6055 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006056 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006057 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006058
6059 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6060 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6061 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6062 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6063 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6064 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6065 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006066 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6067 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6068 possible that the client has already brought one.
6069
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006070 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006071 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006072 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006073 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006074 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006075 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006076
6077 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6078 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6079 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6080 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6081 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6082 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6083 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6084
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006085 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6086 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6087 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6088 are under the control of the end-user.
6089
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006090 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006091 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6092 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006093 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6094 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6095 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006096
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006097 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006098 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6099 frontend www
6100 mode http
6101 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6102
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006103 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6104 backend www
6105 mode http
6106 option forwardfor header X-Client
6107
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006108 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006109 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006110
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006111
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006112option http-buffer-request
6113no option http-buffer-request
6114 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6116 yes | yes | yes | yes
6117 Arguments : none
6118
6119 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6120 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6121 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6122 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6123 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6124 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6125 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6126 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006127 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006128 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6129 default.
6130
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006131 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006132
6133
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006134option http-ignore-probes
6135no option http-ignore-probes
6136 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6138 yes | yes | yes | no
6139 Arguments : none
6140
6141 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6142 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6143 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6144 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6145 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6146 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6147 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6148 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6149 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006150 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6151 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006152 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6153
6154 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6155 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6156 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6157 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6158 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6159 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6160 are often the only way to detect them.
6161
6162 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6163 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6164
6165 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6166
6167
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006168option http-keep-alive
6169no option http-keep-alive
6170 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6172 yes | yes | yes | yes
6173 Arguments : none
6174
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006175 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6176 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006177 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6178 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6179 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6180 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6181 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006182
6183 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6184 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006185 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6186 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6187 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6188 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6189 situations where this option may be useful :
6190
6191 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006192 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006193
6194 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6195 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6196
6197 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6198 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6199 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6200 request.
6201
6202 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6203 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006204 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6205 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6206 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006207
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006208 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6209 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6210 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6211 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6212 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6213 not set.
6214
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006215 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006216 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6217 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006218
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006219 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006220 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006221 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006222
6223
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006224option http-no-delay
6225no option http-no-delay
6226 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6228 yes | yes | yes | yes
6229 Arguments : none
6230
6231 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6232 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6233 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6234 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6235 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6236 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6237 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6238 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6239 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6240 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6241 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6242 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6243 affected.
6244
6245 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6246 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6247 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6248 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6249 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6250 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6251 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6252 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6253 latency environments.
6254
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006255 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6256
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006257
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006258option http-pretend-keepalive
6259no option http-pretend-keepalive
6260 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006262 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006263 Arguments : none
6264
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006265 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006266 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6267 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6268 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6269 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6270 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6271 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6272 consider the response complete.
6273
6274 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6275 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6276 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6277 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006278 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006279 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6280
6281 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6282 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6283 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6284 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6285 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6286 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6287 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6288
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006289 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6290 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6291 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6292 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6293 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6294 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006295
6296 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6297 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6298
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006299 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006300 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006301
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006302
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006303option http-server-close
6304no option http-server-close
6305 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6307 yes | yes | yes | yes
6308 Arguments : none
6309
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006310 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6311 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6312 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6313 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006314 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6315 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6316 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6317 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6318 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6319 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6320 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6321 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6322 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6323 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6324 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006325
6326 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6327 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6328 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6329 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006330 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6331 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006332
6333 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6334 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006335 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6336 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6337 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006338
6339 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6340 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6341
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006342 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6343 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006344
6345
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006346option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6347no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6348 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006350 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006351 Arguments : none
6352
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006353 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6354 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6355 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6356
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006357 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6358 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6359 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6360 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006361 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006362
6363 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006364 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006365 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6366 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6367 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6368 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6369 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6370 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6371 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006372
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006373 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6374 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6375 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6376 backend.
6377
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006378 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6379 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6380
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006381 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6382 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006383
6384
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006385option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006386no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006387 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6389 yes | yes | yes | no
6390 Arguments : none
6391
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006392 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006393 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6394 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6395 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6396 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6397 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6398 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6399
6400 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6401 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006402 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6403 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6404 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006405
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006406 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6407 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6408 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6409 front of an existing proxy.
6410
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006411 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6412
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006413 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006414
6415
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006416option http-use-htx
6417no option http-use-htx
6418 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6420 yes | yes | yes | yes
6421 Arguments : none
6422
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006423 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006424 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006425 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6426 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6427 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6428 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6429 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006430
6431 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6432 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6433 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6434 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006435 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6436 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6437 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6438 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006439
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006440 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6441 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6442 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6443 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6444 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006445
6446 See also : "mode http"
6447
6448
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006449option httpchk
6450option httpchk <uri>
6451option httpchk <method> <uri>
6452option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6453 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6455 yes | no | yes | yes
6456 Arguments :
6457 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6458 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6459 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6460 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6461 ones.
6462
6463 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6464 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6465 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6466
6467 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6468 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6469 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6470 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6471 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6472
6473 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6474 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6475 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6476 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6477 the lack of any response.
6478
6479 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6480
6481 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6482 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6483 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6484
6485 Examples :
6486 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6487 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6488 backend https_relay
6489 mode tcp
6490 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6491 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6492
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006493 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6494 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6495 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006496
6497
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006498option httpclose
6499no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006500 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6502 yes | yes | yes | yes
6503 Arguments : none
6504
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006505 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6506 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6507 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6508 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006509 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006510
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006511 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6512 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6513 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6514 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6515 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006516
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006517 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6518 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6519 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006520
6521 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6522 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006523 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006524 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6525 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6526 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006527
6528 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6529 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6530
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006531 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006532
6533
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006534option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006535 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006537 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006538 Arguments :
6539 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6540 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6541 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006542 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006543 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006544
6545 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6546 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6547 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6548 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6549 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6550 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6551 ports.
6552
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006553 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6554 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006555
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006556 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006558 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006559
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006560
6561option http_proxy
6562no option http_proxy
6563 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6565 yes | yes | yes | yes
6566 Arguments : none
6567
6568 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6569 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6570 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6571 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6572 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6573
6574 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6575 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006576 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6577 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006578
6579 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6580 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6581
6582 Example :
6583 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6584 backend direct_forward
6585 option httpclose
6586 option http_proxy
6587
6588 See also : "option httpclose"
6589
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006590
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006591option independent-streams
6592no option independent-streams
6593 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6595 yes | yes | yes | yes
6596 Arguments : none
6597
6598 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6599 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6600 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6601 receive data or not.
6602
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006603 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006604 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6605 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6606 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6607 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6608 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6609 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6610 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6611 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6612 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6613 socket buffers.
6614
6615 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6616 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6617 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6618 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6619 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6620
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006621 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006622 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6623 deprecated.
6624
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006625 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006626
6627
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006628option ldap-check
6629 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6631 yes | no | yes | yes
6632 Arguments : none
6633
6634 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6635 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6636 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6637 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6638
6639 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6640 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6641
6642 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6643 configure it.
6644
6645 Example :
6646 option ldap-check
6647
6648 See also : "option httpchk"
6649
6650
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006651option external-check
6652 Use external processes for server health checks
6653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6654 yes | no | yes | yes
6655
6656 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6657 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6658 command".
6659
6660 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6661
6662 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6663
6664
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006665option log-health-checks
6666no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006667 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6669 yes | no | yes | yes
6670 Arguments : none
6671
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006672 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6673 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6674 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006675
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006676 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6677 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6678 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6679 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6680 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6681
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006682 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006683 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006684
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006685 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6686 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6687 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006688
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006689
6690option log-separate-errors
6691no option log-separate-errors
6692 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6694 yes | yes | yes | no
6695 Arguments : none
6696
6697 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6698 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6699 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6700 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6701 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6702 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6703 provides very important information.
6704
6705 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6706 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6707 error logs.
6708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006709 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006710 logging.
6711
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006712
6713option logasap
6714no option logasap
6715 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6717 yes | yes | yes | no
6718 Arguments : none
6719
6720 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6721 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6722 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6723 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6724 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6725 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6726 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006727 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006728 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6729 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6730
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006731 Examples :
6732 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6733 mode http
6734 option httplog
6735 option logasap
6736 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6737
6738 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6739 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6740 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6741 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006743 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006744 logging.
6745
6746
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006747option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006748 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6750 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006751 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006752 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6753 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006754 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006755
6756 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6757 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006758 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006759 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6760 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6761 in the MySQL table, like this :
6762
6763 USE mysql;
6764 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6765 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6766
6767 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006768 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006769 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6770 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6771 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6772 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6773 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6774 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6775 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6776
6777 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6778 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006779
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006780 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006781
6782 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6783 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6784 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6785 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006786 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6787 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006788
6789 See also: "option httpchk"
6790
6791
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006792option nolinger
6793no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006794 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6796 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006797 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006798
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006799 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006800 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6801 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6802 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6803 connections.
6804
6805 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6806 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6807 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6808 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6809 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6810 this too.
6811
6812 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6813 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6814 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6815
6816 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6817 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6818 for servers.
6819
6820 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6821 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6822
6823
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006824option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6825 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6827 yes | yes | yes | yes
6828 Arguments :
6829 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6830 matching <network>
6831 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6832 header name.
6833
6834 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6835 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6836 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6837 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6838 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6839 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6840 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6841 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6842 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6843 possible that the client has already brought one.
6844
6845 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6846 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6847 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6848 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6849 header and requires different one.
6850
6851 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6852 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6853 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6854 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6855 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6856 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6857 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6858
6859 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6860 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6861 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6862 both are defined.
6863
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006864 Examples :
6865 # Original Destination address
6866 frontend www
6867 mode http
6868 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6869
6870 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6871 backend www
6872 mode http
6873 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6874
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006875 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006876
6877
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006878option persist
6879no option persist
6880 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6881 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6882 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006883 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006884
6885 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6886 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6887 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6888 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6889 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6890 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6891 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6892 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6893 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6894 redirected to another valid server.
6895
6896 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6897 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6898
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006899 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006900
6901
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006902option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6903 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6905 yes | no | yes | yes
6906 Arguments :
6907 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6908 PostgreSQL server.
6909
6910 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6911 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6912 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6913 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6914
6915 See also: "option httpchk"
6916
6917
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006918option prefer-last-server
6919no option prefer-last-server
6920 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6921 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6922 yes | no | yes | yes
6923 Arguments : none
6924
6925 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6926 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6927 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6928 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6929 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6930 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6931 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6932 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6933 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006934 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6935 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006936 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6937 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6938 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006939 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6940 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6941 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006942
6943 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6944 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6945
6946 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6947
6948
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006949option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006950option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006951no option redispatch
6952 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6953 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6954 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006955 Arguments :
6956 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6957 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6958 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006959 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006960 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006961 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006962 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6963 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6964 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6965
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006966
6967 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6968 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6969 be able to access the service anymore.
6970
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006971 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6972 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006973
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006974 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006975 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6976 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006977
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006978 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6979 "redisp" keywords.
6980
6981 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6982 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6983
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006984 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006985
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006986
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006987option redis-check
6988 Use redis health checks for server testing
6989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6990 yes | no | yes | yes
6991 Arguments : none
6992
6993 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6994 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6995 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6996 find the "+PONG" response message.
6997
6998 Example :
6999 option redis-check
7000
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007001 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007002
7003
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007004option smtpchk
7005option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7006 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7008 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007009 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007010 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007011 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007012 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7013
7014 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7015 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7016 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7017
7018 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7019 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7020 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7021 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7022 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7023 dead server.
7024
7025 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7026 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007027 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007028 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7029
7030 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7031 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7032 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7033 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007034 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007035
7036 Example :
7037 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7038
7039 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007041
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007042option socket-stats
7043no option socket-stats
7044
7045 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7047 yes | yes | yes | no
7048
7049 Arguments : none
7050
7051
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007052option splice-auto
7053no option splice-auto
7054 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7056 yes | yes | yes | yes
7057 Arguments : none
7058
7059 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7060 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007061 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007062 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007063 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007064 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7065 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7066 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7067 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7068
7069 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7070 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7071 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7072 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7073 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7074 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7075 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7076 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7077 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7078 keyword.
7079
7080 Example :
7081 option splice-auto
7082
7083 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7084 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7085
7086 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7087 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7088
7089
7090option splice-request
7091no option splice-request
7092 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7094 yes | yes | yes | yes
7095 Arguments : none
7096
7097 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007098 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007099 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7100 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7101 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7102 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7103
7104 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7105
7106 Example :
7107 option splice-request
7108
7109 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7110 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7111
7112 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7113 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7114
7115
7116option splice-response
7117no option splice-response
7118 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7120 yes | yes | yes | yes
7121 Arguments : none
7122
7123 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007124 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007125 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7126 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7127 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7128 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7129
7130 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7131
7132 Example :
7133 option splice-response
7134
7135 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7136 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7137
7138 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7139 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7140
7141
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007142option spop-check
7143 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7145 no | no | no | yes
7146 Arguments : none
7147
7148 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7149 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7150 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7151 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7152
7153 Example :
7154 option spop-check
7155
7156 See also : "option httpchk"
7157
7158
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007159option srvtcpka
7160no option srvtcpka
7161 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7163 yes | no | yes | yes
7164 Arguments : none
7165
7166 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7167 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007168 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007169 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7170
7171 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7172 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7173 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7174 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7175
7176 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7177 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7178 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7179 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7180 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7181
7182 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7183
7184 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7185 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7186 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7187
7188 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7189 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7190
7191 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7192
7193
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007194option ssl-hello-chk
7195 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7197 yes | no | yes | yes
7198 Arguments : none
7199
7200 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7201 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7202 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7203 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7204 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7205 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7206 hello message.
7207
7208 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7209 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7210 messages, which is appreciable.
7211
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007212 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7213 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7214 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007215
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007216 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7217
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007218
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007219option tcp-check
7220 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7221 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7222 yes | no | yes | yes
7223
7224 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7225 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7226
7227 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7228 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7229 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7230
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007231 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007232 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7233 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7234 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7235 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7236 only.
7237
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007238 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007239 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7240 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7241 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7242 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7243
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007244 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007245 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7246 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007247 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007248 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7249 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7250 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7251 the respective protocols.
7252 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007253 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007254
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007255 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7256 script.
7257
7258 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7259 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7260 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7261 The "comment" is of course optional.
7262
7263
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007264 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007265 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007266 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007267 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007268
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007269 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007270 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007271 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007272
7273 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7274 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007275 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007276 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007277 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007278 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007279 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007280 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007281 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7282 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007283 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007284 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7285 tcp-check expect string +OK
7286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007287 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007288 (send many headers before analyzing)
7289 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007290 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007291 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7292 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7293 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7294 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007295 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007296
7297
7298 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7299
7300
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007301option tcp-smart-accept
7302no option tcp-smart-accept
7303 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7305 yes | yes | yes | no
7306 Arguments : none
7307
7308 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7309 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7310 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7311 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7312 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7313 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7314
7315 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7316 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7317 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7318 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7319
7320 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7321 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7322 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007323 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007324
7325 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7326 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7327 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7328
7329 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7330 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7331 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7332
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007333 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7334
7335
7336option tcp-smart-connect
7337no option tcp-smart-connect
7338 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7340 yes | no | yes | yes
7341 Arguments : none
7342
7343 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7344 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7345 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7346 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7347 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7348
7349 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7350 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7351 complex.
7352
7353 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7354 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7355 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7356
7357 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7358 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7359
7360 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7361
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007362
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007363option tcpka
7364 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7366 yes | yes | yes | yes
7367 Arguments : none
7368
7369 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7370 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007371 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007372 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7373
7374 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7375 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7376 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7377 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7378
7379 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7380 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7381 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7382 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7383 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7384
7385 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7386
7387 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7388 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7389 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7390 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7391 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7392 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7393 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7394 backends.
7395
7396 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7397
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007398
7399option tcplog
7400 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007402 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007403 Arguments : none
7404
7405 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7406 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7407 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7408 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7409 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7410 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7411 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7412 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7413
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007414 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7415
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007416 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007417
7418
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007419option transparent
7420no option transparent
7421 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007423 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007424 Arguments : none
7425
7426 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7427 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7428 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7429 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7430 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7431 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7432 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7433 appropriate server.
7434
7435 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7436 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7437
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007438 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007439 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007440
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007441
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007442external-check command <command>
7443 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7445 yes | no | yes | yes
7446
7447 Arguments :
7448 <command> is the external command to run
7449
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007450 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7451
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007452 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007453
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007454 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7455 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7456 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7457 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7458 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7459 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007460
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007461 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7462
7463 Environment variables :
7464 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7465 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7466
7467 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7468
7469 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7470
7471 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7472 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7473 for a UNIX socket).
7474
7475 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7476
7477 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7478
7479 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7480
7481 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7482
7483 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7484
7485 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7486 socket).
7487
7488 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7489 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7490
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007491 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7492 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7493 failed.
7494
7495 Example :
7496 external-check command /bin/true
7497
7498 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7499
7500
7501external-check path <path>
7502 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7504 yes | no | yes | yes
7505
7506 Arguments :
7507 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7508
7509 The default path is "".
7510
7511 Example :
7512 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7513
7514 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7515 "external-check command"
7516
7517
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007518persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007519persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007520 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7522 yes | no | yes | yes
7523 Arguments :
7524 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007525 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7526 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007527
7528 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7529 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007530 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007531 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7532 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7533 forwarded to this server.
7534
7535 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7536 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7537 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007538 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007539 a single "listen" section.
7540
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007541 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7542 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7543 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7544
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007545 Example :
7546 listen tse-farm
7547 bind :3389
7548 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7549 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7550 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7551 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7552 persist rdp-cookie
7553 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007554 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007555 balance rdp-cookie
7556 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7557 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7558
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007559 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7560 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007561
7562
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007563rate-limit sessions <rate>
7564 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7566 yes | yes | yes | no
7567 Arguments :
7568 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7569 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7570
7571 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7572 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7573 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7574 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7575 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7576 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7577
7578 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7579 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7580 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7581 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7582
7583 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7584 listen smtp
7585 mode tcp
7586 bind :25
7587 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007588 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007589
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007590 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7591 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7592 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007593
7594 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7595
7596
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007597redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7598redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7599redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007600 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7602 no | yes | yes | yes
7603
7604 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007605 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007606
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007607 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007608 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007609 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7610 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7611 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007612
7613 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7614 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7615 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7616 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7617 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007618 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7619 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7620 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7621 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007622
7623 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7624 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7625 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7626 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7627 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7628 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007629 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007630 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007631 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7632 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7633 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007634
7635 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007636 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7637 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7638 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007639 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007640 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7641 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7642 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7643 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007644
7645 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007646 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007647
7648 - "drop-query"
7649 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7650 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7651 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7652 with a location-type redirect.
7653
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007654 - "append-slash"
7655 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7656 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7657 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7658 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7659
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007660 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7661 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7662 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7663 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7664 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7665 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7666 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7667
7668 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7669 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7670 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7671 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7672 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7673 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7674 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007675
7676 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7677 acl clear dst_port 80
7678 acl secure dst_port 8080
7679 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007680 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007681 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007682 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7683
7684 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007685 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7686 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7687 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007688 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007689
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007690 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7691 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7692 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7693
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007694 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007695 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007696
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007697 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007698 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7699 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7700 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007702 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007703
7704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007705redisp (deprecated)
7706redispatch (deprecated)
7707 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7708 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7709 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007710 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007711
7712 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7713 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7714 be able to access the service anymore.
7715
7716 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7717 redistribute them to a working server.
7718
7719 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7720 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7721 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007722
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007723 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7724 "option redispatch" instead.
7725
7726 See also : "option redispatch"
7727
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007728
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007729reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007730 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7732 no | yes | yes | yes
7733 Arguments :
7734 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7735 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007736 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007737
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007738 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7739 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7740
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007741 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7742 the last header of an HTTP request.
7743
7744 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7745 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7746 responses.
7747
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007748 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7749 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7750 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7751
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007752 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7753 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007754
7755
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007756reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7757reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007758 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7760 no | yes | yes | yes
7761 Arguments :
7762 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7763 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7764 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7765 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7766 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7767 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7768 ignores case.
7769
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007770 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7771 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7772
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007773 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7774 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7775 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7776 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007777 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007778
7779 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7780 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7781
7782 Example :
7783 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7784 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7785 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7786
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007787 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7788 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007789
7790
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007791reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7792reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007793 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7795 no | yes | yes | yes
7796 Arguments :
7797 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7798 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7799 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7800 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7801 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7802 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7803
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007804 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7805 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7806
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007807 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7808 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7809 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7810 next servers.
7811
7812 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7813 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7814 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7815
7816 Example :
7817 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7818 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7819 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7820
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007821 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7822 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007823
7824
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007825reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7826reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007827 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7829 no | yes | yes | yes
7830 Arguments :
7831 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7832 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7833 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7834 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7835 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7836 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7837 case.
7838
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007839 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7840 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7841
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007842 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7843 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7844 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7845 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007846 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007847
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007848 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007849 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007850 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007851
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007852 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7853 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7854
7855 Example :
7856 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7857 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7858 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7859
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007860 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7861 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007862
7863
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007864reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7865reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007866 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7868 no | yes | yes | yes
7869 Arguments :
7870 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7871 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7872 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7873 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7874 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7875 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7876 case.
7877
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007878 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7879 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7880
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007881 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7882 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7883 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7884 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7885
7886 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7887 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7888
7889 Example :
7890 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7891 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7892 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7893 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7894
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007895 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7896 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007897
7898
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007899reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7900reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007901 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7903 no | yes | yes | yes
7904 Arguments :
7905 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7906 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7907 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7908 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7909 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7910 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7911
7912 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7913 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7914 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7915 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007916 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007917
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007918 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7919 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7920
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007921 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7922 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7923 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7924
7925 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7926 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7927 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7928 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7929 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7930
7931 Example :
7932 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007933 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007934 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7935 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7936
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007937 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7938 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007939
7940
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007941reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7942reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007943 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7945 no | yes | yes | yes
7946 Arguments :
7947 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7948 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7949 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7950 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7951 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7952 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7953 ignores case.
7954
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007955 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7956 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7957
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007958 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7959 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007960 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7961 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7962 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007963 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7964 not set.
7965
7966 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7967 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7968 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7969 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7970 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7971
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007972 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007973 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007974 # block all others.
7975 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7976 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7977
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007978 # block bad guys
7979 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7980 reqitarpit . if badguys
7981
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007982 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7983 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007984
7985
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007986retries <value>
7987 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7988 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7989 yes | no | yes | yes
7990 Arguments :
7991 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7992 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7993 default value is 3.
7994
7995 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7996 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7997 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7998
7999 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008000 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8001 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008002
8003 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8004 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8005
8006 See also : "option redispatch"
8007
8008
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008009retry-on [list of keywords]
8010 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8012 yes | no | yes | yes
8013 Arguments :
8014 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8015 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8016 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8017 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8018
8019 none never retry
8020
8021 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8022 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8023
8024 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8025 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8026 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8027 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8028 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8029 processing the request.
8030
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008031 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8032 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8033 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8034 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8035 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8036 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8037 overflow attack for example).
8038
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008039 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8040 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8041 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8042 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8043 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8044 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8045 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8046 amplify denial of service attacks.
8047
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008048 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8049 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8050 considered to be safe to retry.
8051
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008052 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8053 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8054 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8055 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8056
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008057 all-retryable-errors
8058 retry request for any error that are considered
8059 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8060 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8061 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8062
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008063 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8064 not cumulative.
8065
8066 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8067 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8068 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8069 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8070
8071 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8072 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8073 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8074 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8075 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8076 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8077 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8078 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8079 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8080 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8081 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8082 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8083
8084 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8085 should not use this directive.
8086
8087 The default is "conn-failure".
8088
8089 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8090
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008091rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008092 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8094 no | yes | yes | yes
8095 Arguments :
8096 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8097 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008098 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008099
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008100 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8101 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8102
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008103 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8104 the last header of an HTTP response.
8105
8106 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8107 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8108 responses.
8109
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008110 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8111 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008112
8113
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008114rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8115rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008116 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8118 no | yes | yes | yes
8119 Arguments :
8120 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8121 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8122 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8123 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8124 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8125 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8126 ignores case.
8127
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008128 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8129 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8130
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008131 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8132 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008133 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008134 client.
8135
8136 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8137 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8138 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8139
8140 Example :
8141 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008142 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008143
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008144 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8145 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008146
8147
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008148rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8149rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008150 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8152 no | yes | yes | yes
8153 Arguments :
8154 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8155 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8156 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8157 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8158 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8159 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8160 ignores case.
8161
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008162 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8163 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8164
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008165 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8166 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8167 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8168 case-sensitive.
8169
8170 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008171 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8172 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8173 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008174
8175 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8176 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8177
8178 Example :
8179 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8180 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8181
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008182 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8183 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008184
8185
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008186rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8187rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008188 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8190 no | yes | yes | yes
8191 Arguments :
8192 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8193 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8194 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8195 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8196 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8197 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8198 ignores case.
8199
8200 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8201 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8202 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8203 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008204 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008205
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008206 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8207 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8208
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008209 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8210 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8211 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8212
8213 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8214 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8215 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8216 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8217 are not case-sensitive.
8218
8219 Example :
8220 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8221 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8222
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008223 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8224 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008225
8226
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008227server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008228 Declare a server in a backend
8229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8230 no | no | yes | yes
8231 Arguments :
8232 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008233 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008234 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008235
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008236 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8237 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8238 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8239 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008240 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8241 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8242 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8243 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8244 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008245 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8246 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8247 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8248 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8249 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8250 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8251 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008252 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008253 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8254 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8255 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8256 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8257 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8258 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008259 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8260 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008261 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8262 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008263
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008264 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008265 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8266 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8267 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8268 adding this value to the client's port.
8269
8270 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8271 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008272 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008273
8274 Examples :
8275 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8276 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008277 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008278 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8279 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8280 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008281
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008282 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8283 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8284 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8285 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8286 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8287
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008288 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8289 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008290
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008291server-state-file-name [<file>]
8292 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8293 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8294 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8295 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8296 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8297 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8298
8299 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8300 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8301
8302 global
8303 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8304
8305 backend bk
8306 load-server-state-from-file
8307
8308 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8309 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008310
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008311server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8312 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8313 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8315 no | no | yes | yes
8316
8317 Arguments:
8318 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8319
8320 <num | range>
8321 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8322 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8323 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8324 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8325
8326 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8327
8328 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8329
8330 <params*>
8331 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8332 keyword.
8333
8334 Examples:
8335 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8336 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8337 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8338
8339 # or
8340 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8341
8342 # would be equivalent to:
8343 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8344 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8345 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8346
8347
8348
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008349source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008350source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008351source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008352 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8354 yes | no | yes | yes
8355 Arguments :
8356 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8357 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008358
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008359 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008360 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8361 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8362 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8363 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8364 supported prefixes are :
8365 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8366 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8367 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008368 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008369 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8370 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008371
8372 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8373 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008374 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8375 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8376 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008377
8378 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8379 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8380 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8381 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8382 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8383 <addr>.
8384
8385 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8386 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8387 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8388 port.
8389
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008390 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8391 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8392 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8393 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008394 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008395 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8396 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8397 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8398 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8399 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8400 HTTP header.
8401
8402 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8403 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008404 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008405 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8406 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8407 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8408 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8409 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8410 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8411 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8412
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008413 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8414 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8415 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8416 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8417 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8418 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8419
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008420 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8421 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8422 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8423 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8424
8425 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8426 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8427 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8428 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8429 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8430 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8431
8432 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8433 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8434 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8435 there are two methods :
8436
8437 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8438 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8439 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8440 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8441 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8442 of the client ranges may be used.
8443
8444 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8445 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8446 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8447 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8448 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8449 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8450 same session.
8451
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008452 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8453 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8454 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008455 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008456
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008457 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8458
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008459 Examples :
8460 backend private
8461 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8462 source 192.168.1.200
8463
8464 backend transparent_ssl1
8465 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8466 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8467
8468 backend transparent_ssl2
8469 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8470 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8471 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8472
8473 backend transparent_ssl3
8474 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8475 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8476 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8477
8478 backend transparent_smtp
8479 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8480 # with Tproxy version 4.
8481 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8482
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008483 backend transparent_http
8484 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8485 # proxy.
8486 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008488 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008489 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008491
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008492srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8493 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8495 yes | no | yes | yes
8496 Arguments :
8497 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8498 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8499 as explained at the top of this document.
8500
8501 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8502 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8503 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8504 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8505 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8506 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8507 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8508
8509 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8510 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8511 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8512 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8513 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008514 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008515 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008516 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008517
8518 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8519 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8520 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8521 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8522 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8523 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8524
8525 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8526 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8527
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008528 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8529 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008530
8531
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008532stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8533 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008535 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008536
8537 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8538 matched.
8539
8540 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8541 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8542
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008543 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8544 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008545 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008546
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008547 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8548 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8549 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8550 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008551
8552 Example :
8553 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8554 backend stats_localhost
8555 stats enable
8556 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8557
8558 Example :
8559 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8560 backend stats_auth
8561 stats enable
8562 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8563 stats admin if TRUE
8564
8565 Example :
8566 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8567 userlist stats-auth
8568 group admin users admin
8569 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8570 group readonly users haproxy
8571 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8572
8573 backend stats_auth
8574 stats enable
8575 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8576 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8577 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8578 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8579
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008580 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8581 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8582 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008583
8584
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008585stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8586 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008588 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008589 Arguments :
8590 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8591
8592 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8593
8594 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8595 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8596 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8597 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8598 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8599 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8600
8601 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8602 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8603 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008604 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008605
8606 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8607 report using "stats scope".
8608
8609 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8610 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8611 unobvious parameters.
8612
8613 Example :
8614 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8615 backend public_www
8616 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8617 stats enable
8618 stats hide-version
8619 stats scope .
8620 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008621 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008622 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8623 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8624
8625 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8626 backend private_monitoring
8627 stats enable
8628 stats uri /admin?stats
8629 stats refresh 5s
8630
8631 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8632
8633
8634stats enable
8635 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008637 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008638 Arguments : none
8639
8640 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8641 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8642 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8643 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8644 - stats auth : no authentication
8645 - stats scope : no restriction
8646
8647 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8648 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8649 unobvious parameters.
8650
8651 Example :
8652 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8653 backend public_www
8654 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8655 stats enable
8656 stats hide-version
8657 stats scope .
8658 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008659 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008660 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8661 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8662
8663 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8664 backend private_monitoring
8665 stats enable
8666 stats uri /admin?stats
8667 stats refresh 5s
8668
8669 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8670
8671
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008672stats hide-version
8673 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008675 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008676 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008677
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008678 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8679 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8680 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8681 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8682 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8683 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008684
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008685 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8686 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8687 unobvious parameters.
8688
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008689 Example :
8690 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8691 backend public_www
8692 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008693 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008694 stats hide-version
8695 stats scope .
8696 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008697 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008698 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8699 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008700
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008701 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8702 backend private_monitoring
8703 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008704 stats uri /admin?stats
8705 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008706
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008707 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008708
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008709
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008710stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8711 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8712 Access control for statistics
8713
8714 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8715 no | no | yes | yes
8716
8717 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8718 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8719 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8720 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8721 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8722 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8723
8724 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8725 instance.
8726
8727 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8728 about ACL usage.
8729
8730
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008731stats realm <realm>
8732 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008734 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008735 Arguments :
8736 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8737 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8738 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8739
8740 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8741 using a backslash ('\').
8742
8743 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8744 only related to authentication.
8745
8746 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8747 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8748 unobvious parameters.
8749
8750 Example :
8751 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8752 backend public_www
8753 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8754 stats enable
8755 stats hide-version
8756 stats scope .
8757 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008758 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008759 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8760 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8761
8762 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8763 backend private_monitoring
8764 stats enable
8765 stats uri /admin?stats
8766 stats refresh 5s
8767
8768 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8769
8770
8771stats refresh <delay>
8772 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008774 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008775 Arguments :
8776 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8777 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8778 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8779 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8780 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8781 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8782
8783 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8784 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8785 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8786 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8787
8788 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8789 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8790 unobvious parameters.
8791
8792 Example :
8793 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8794 backend public_www
8795 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8796 stats enable
8797 stats hide-version
8798 stats scope .
8799 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008800 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008801 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8802 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8803
8804 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8805 backend private_monitoring
8806 stats enable
8807 stats uri /admin?stats
8808 stats refresh 5s
8809
8810 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8811
8812
8813stats scope { <name> | "." }
8814 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008816 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008817 Arguments :
8818 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8819 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8820 section in which the statement appears.
8821
8822 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8823 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8824 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8825 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8826 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8827 exists.
8828
8829 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8830 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8831 unobvious parameters.
8832
8833 Example :
8834 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8835 backend public_www
8836 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8837 stats enable
8838 stats hide-version
8839 stats scope .
8840 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008841 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008842 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8843 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8844
8845 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8846 backend private_monitoring
8847 stats enable
8848 stats uri /admin?stats
8849 stats refresh 5s
8850
8851 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8852
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008853
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008854stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008855 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008857 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008858
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008859 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008860 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8861
8862 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8863 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8864
8865 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8866 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008867 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008868
8869 Example :
8870 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8871 backend private_monitoring
8872 stats enable
8873 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8874 stats uri /admin?stats
8875 stats refresh 5s
8876
8877 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8878 global section.
8879
8880
8881stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008882 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8884 yes | yes | yes | yes
8885 Arguments : none
8886
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008887 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008888 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8889 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8890 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8891 - IP (socket, server)
8892 - cookie (backend, server)
8893
8894 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8895 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008896 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008897
8898 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8899
8900
8901stats show-node [ <name> ]
8902 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008904 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008905 Arguments:
8906 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8907 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8908
8909 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8910 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008911 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008912
8913 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8914 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8915 unobvious parameters.
8916
8917 Example:
8918 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8919 backend private_monitoring
8920 stats enable
8921 stats show-node Europe-1
8922 stats uri /admin?stats
8923 stats refresh 5s
8924
8925 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8926 section.
8927
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008928
8929stats uri <prefix>
8930 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008932 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008933 Arguments :
8934 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8935 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8936 query string.
8937
8938 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8939 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8940 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8941 possible to reach it in the application.
8942
8943 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008944 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008945 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8946 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8947 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8948 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8949
8950 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8951 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8952 an address or a port to statistics only.
8953
8954 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8955 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8956 unobvious parameters.
8957
8958 Example :
8959 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8960 backend public_www
8961 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8962 stats enable
8963 stats hide-version
8964 stats scope .
8965 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008966 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008967 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8968 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8969
8970 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8971 backend private_monitoring
8972 stats enable
8973 stats uri /admin?stats
8974 stats refresh 5s
8975
8976 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8977
8978
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008979stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8980 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008982 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008983
8984 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008985 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008986 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008987 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008988 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8989
8990 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8991 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8992 the "stick-table" statement.
8993
8994 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8995 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8996 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8997 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8998 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8999
9000 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9001 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9002 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9003 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9004 transformation rules.
9005
9006 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9007 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9008 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9009 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9010 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9011 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9012 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9013
9014 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9015 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9016 ACL based conditions.
9017
9018 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9019 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9020 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9021 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9022
9023 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9024 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9025 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9026 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9027
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009028 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9029 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009030 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009031
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009032 Example :
9033 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9034 # last 30 minutes
9035 backend pop
9036 mode tcp
9037 balance roundrobin
9038 stick store-request src
9039 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9040 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9041 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9042
9043 backend smtp
9044 mode tcp
9045 balance roundrobin
9046 stick match src table pop
9047 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9048 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9049
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009050 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009051 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009052
9053
9054stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9055 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9057 no | no | yes | yes
9058
9059 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9060 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9061 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9062 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9063
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009064 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9065 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009066 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009067
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009068 Examples :
9069 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009070 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009071
9072 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9073 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9074 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9075
9076
9077 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9078 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9079 backend http
9080 mode http
9081 balance roundrobin
9082 stick on src table https
9083 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9084 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9085 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9086
9087 backend https
9088 mode tcp
9089 balance roundrobin
9090 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9091 stick on src
9092 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9093 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9094
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009095 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009096
9097
9098stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9099 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9101 no | no | yes | yes
9102
9103 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009104 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009105 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009106 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009107 server is selected.
9108
9109 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9110 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9111 the "stick-table" statement.
9112
9113 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9114 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9115 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9116 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9117 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9118 address.
9119
9120 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9121 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9122 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9123 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9124 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9125 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9126 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9127 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9128 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9129 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9130
9131 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9132 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9133 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9134 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9135 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9136 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9137 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9138
9139 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9140 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9141 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9142 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9143
9144 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9145 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9146 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9147 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9148 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9149 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009150 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9151 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9152 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9153 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9154 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9155 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009156
9157 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9158 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9159 the request.
9160
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009161 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9162 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009163 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009164
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009165 Example :
9166 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9167 # last 30 minutes
9168 backend pop
9169 mode tcp
9170 balance roundrobin
9171 stick store-request src
9172 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9173 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9174 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9175
9176 backend smtp
9177 mode tcp
9178 balance roundrobin
9179 stick match src table pop
9180 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9181 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9182
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009183 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009184 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009185
9186
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009187stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009188 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9189 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009190 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009192 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009193
9194 Arguments :
9195 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9196 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9197 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9198 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9199
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009200 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9201 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9202 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9203 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9204
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009205 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9206 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9207 instance.
9208
9209 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9210 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9211 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9212 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9213 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9214 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009215 to 32 characters.
9216
9217 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9218 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9219 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009220 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009221 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9222 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009223
9224 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009225 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9226 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009227 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9228 increase.
9229
9230 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009231 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9232 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9233 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009234
9235 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9236 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9237 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9238 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009239 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009240 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9241 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9242 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9243 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9244 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9245 parameter (see below).
9246
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009247 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9248 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9249 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9250 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9251 soft restart.
9252
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009253 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9254 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009255
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009256 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9257 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9258 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9259 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009260 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009261 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009262 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9263 if not expiration delay is specified.
9264
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009265 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9266 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9267 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9268 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009269 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9270 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9271 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9272 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9273 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9274 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9275 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9276 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9277 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9278 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9279 types and their arguments.
9280
9281 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9282 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9283 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9284 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9285
9286 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9287 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9288 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009289 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009290
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009291 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9292 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9293 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009294 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009295 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009296 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009297
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009298 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9299 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9300 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9301 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9302
9303 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9304 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9305 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9306 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9307 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9308 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9309
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009310 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9311 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9312 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9313 they were received.
9314
9315 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9316 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9317 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9318 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9319 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9320
9321 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9322 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9323 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9324 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9325 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9326
9327 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9328 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9329 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9330
9331 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9332 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9333 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9334 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9335 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9336
9337 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9338 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9339 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9340 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9341 the client side.
9342
9343 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9344 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9345 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9346 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9347 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9348 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9349 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9350
9351 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9352 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9353 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9354 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9355 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9356 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009357 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009358
9359 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9360 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9361 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9362 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9363 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9364 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9365
9366 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009367 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009368 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9369 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9370
9371 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9372 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9373 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9374 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9375 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9376 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9377 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9378 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9379 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9380 recommended for better fairness.
9381
9382 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009383 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009384 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9385 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9386
9387 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9388 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9389 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9390 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9391 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9392 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9393 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9394 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9395 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9396 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009397
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009398 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9399 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009400 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9401 reference it.
9402
9403 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9404 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009405 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9406 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9407 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009408
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009409 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9410 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9411 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9412 something that can be ignored.
9413
9414 Example:
9415 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9416 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9417 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9418 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9419
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009420 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009421 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009422
9423
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009424stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009425 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9427 no | no | yes | yes
9428
9429 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009430 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009431 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009432 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009433 server is selected.
9434
9435 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9436 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9437 the "stick-table" statement.
9438
9439 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9440 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9441 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9442 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9443
9444 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9445 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9446 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9447 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9448 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9449 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009450 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009451 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9452 rules.
9453
9454 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9455 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9456 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9457 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9458 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9459 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9460 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9461
9462 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9463 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9464 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9465 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9466
9467 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9468 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9469 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9470 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9471 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9472 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009473 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9474 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9475 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9476 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9477 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9478 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9479 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9480 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9481 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009482
9483 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9484
9485 Example :
9486 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9487 backend https
9488 mode tcp
9489 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009490 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009491 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009492
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009493 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9494 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9495
9496 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9497 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9498 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9499
9500 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9501 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009502
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009503 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9504 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9505 # at offset 44.
9506
9507 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9508 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9509
9510 # Learn on response if server hello.
9511 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009512
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009513 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9514 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9515
9516 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9517 extraction.
9518
9519
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009520tcp-check connect [params*]
9521 Opens a new connection
9522 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9523 no | no | yes | yes
9524
9525 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9526 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9527 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9528
9529 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9530 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9531 of the sequence.
9532
9533 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9534 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9535 do.
9536
9537 Parameters :
9538 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9539 use the TCP connection.
9540
9541 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9542 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9543 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9544
9545 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9546
9547 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9548
9549 Examples:
9550 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9551 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9552 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9553 option tcp-check
9554 tcp-check connect
9555 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9556 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9557 tcp-check send \r\n
9558 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9559 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9560 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9561 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9562 tcp-check send \r\n
9563 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9564 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9565
9566 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9567 option tcp-check
9568 tcp-check connect port 110
9569 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9570 tcp-check connect port 143
9571 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9572 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9573
9574 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9575
9576
9577tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009578 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009579 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9580 no | no | yes | yes
9581
9582 Arguments :
9583 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9584 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9585 binary.
9586 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9587 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9588 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9589
9590 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9591 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9592 with the usual backslash ('\').
9593 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009594 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009595 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9596 used upper or lower case.
9597
9598
9599 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9600
9601 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9602 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9603 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9604 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9605 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9606 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9607 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9608 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9609
9610 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9611 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9612 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9613 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9614 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9615 expression.
9616
9617 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9618 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9619 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9620 this exact hexadecimal string.
9621 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9622
9623 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9624 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9625 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9626 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9627 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9628 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9629 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9630 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9631 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9632 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9633 the null character.
9634
9635 Examples :
9636 # perform a POP check
9637 option tcp-check
9638 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9639
9640 # perform an IMAP check
9641 option tcp-check
9642 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9643
9644 # look for the redis master server
9645 option tcp-check
9646 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009647 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009648 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9649 tcp-check expect string role:master
9650 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9651 tcp-check expect string +OK
9652
9653
9654 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9655 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9656
9657
9658tcp-check send <data>
9659 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9660 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9661 no | no | yes | yes
9662
9663 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9664 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9665
9666 Examples :
9667 # look for the redis master server
9668 option tcp-check
9669 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9670 tcp-check expect string role:master
9671
9672 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9673 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9674
9675
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009676tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9677 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009678 tcp health check
9679 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9680 no | no | yes | yes
9681
9682 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9683 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009684 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009685 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9686 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9687 hexadecimal string.
9688 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9689
9690 Examples :
9691 # redis check in binary
9692 option tcp-check
9693 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9694 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9695
9696
9697 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9698 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9699
9700
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009701tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9702 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9704 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009705 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009706 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9707 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009708
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009709 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009710
9711 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9712 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009713 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9714 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9715 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9716 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9717 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9718 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009719
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009720 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9721 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9722 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9723 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009724
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009725 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009726 - accept :
9727 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9728 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9729 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009730
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009731 - reject :
9732 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9733 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9734 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9735 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9736 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9737 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9738 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9739 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9740 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9741 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9742 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009743 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009744
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009745 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9746 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9747 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9748 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9749 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9750 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9751 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9752 hosts.
9753
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009754 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9755 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9756 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9757 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9758 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9759 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9760 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9761 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9762
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009763 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9764 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9765 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9766 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9767 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9768 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9769 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9770 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9771 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009772 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9773 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009774
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009775 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009776 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009777 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9778 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9779 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9780 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9781 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9782 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9783 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9784 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9785 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9786 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9787 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9788 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009789
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009790 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009791 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009792 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009793 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009794 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9795 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9796 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009797
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009798 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9799 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9800 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9801 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009802
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009803 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9804 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9805 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9806 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9807 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009808 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9809 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9810 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9811 layer7 information is extracted.
9812
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009813 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9814 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9815 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9816 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9817 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009818
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009819 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9820 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9821 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9822 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9823
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009824 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9825 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9826 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9827 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9828
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009829 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9830 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9831 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9832 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9833 continues.
9834
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009835 - set-src <expr> :
9836 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9837 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9838 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009839 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009840
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009841 Arguments:
9842 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9843 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009844
9845 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009846 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9847
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009848 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9849 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009850
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009851 - set-src-port <expr> :
9852 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9853 expression.
9854
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009855 Arguments:
9856 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9857 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009858
9859 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009860 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9861
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009862 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9863 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9864 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009865
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009866 - set-dst <expr> :
9867 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9868 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9869 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9870 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9871 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9872
9873 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9874 followed by some converters.
9875
9876 Example:
9877
9878 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9879 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9880
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009881 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9882 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9883
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009884 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9885 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9886 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9887 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9888
9889
9890 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9891 followed by some converters.
9892
9893 Example:
9894
9895 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9896
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009897 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9898 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9899 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9900
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009901 - "silent-drop" :
9902 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009903 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009904 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9905 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9906 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9907 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9908 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009909 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9910 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009911 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9912 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009913 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009914 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9915 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9916 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9917 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9918
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009919 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9920 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9921 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009922
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009923 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9924 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9925 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009926
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009927 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009928 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009929 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009930
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009931 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9932 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9933 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009934
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009935 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009936 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9937 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009938
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009939 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9940
9941 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9942
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009943 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9944
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009945 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009946
9947
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009948tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9949 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009951 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009952 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009953 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9954 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009955
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009956 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009957
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009958 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009959 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9960 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9961 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9962 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009963
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009964 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9965 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9966 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9967 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009968 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9969 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9970 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9971 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9972 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9973 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009974 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009975 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009976
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009977 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9978 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9979 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9980 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009981
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009982 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009983 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009984 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009985 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9986 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009987 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009988 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009989 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009990 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009991 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009992 - set-dst <expr>
9993 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009994 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009995 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009996 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009997 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009998
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009999 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10000 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010001 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10002 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010003
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010004 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10005 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10006 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10007 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10008 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10009 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010010
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010011 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010012 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10013 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010014
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010015 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010016 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10017 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10018 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10019 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010020 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10021 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10022 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010023
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010024 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010025 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10026 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10027 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010028
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010029 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10030 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10031
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010032 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010033 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10034 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010035
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010036 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10037 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010038 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010039 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10040 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010041 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010042 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010043 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010044 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10045 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010046 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010047 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10048 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010049
10050 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10051 followed by some converters.
10052
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010053 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10054 <var-name>.
10055
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010056 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10057 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10058 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10059 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10060 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10061
10062 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10063 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10064 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10065 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10066 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10067 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10068 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10069 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10070 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10071 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10072 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10073
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010074 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10075 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10076 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10077 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10078 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10079
10080 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10081
10082 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10083
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010084 Example:
10085
10086 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010087 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010088
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010089 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010090 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10091 # and reject everything else.
10092 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10093 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010094 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010095 tcp-request content reject
10096
10097 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010098 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10099 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10100 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010101 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010102
10103 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10104 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10105 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010106 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010107 tcp-request content reject
10108
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010109 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010110 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010111 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010112 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010113 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10114 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010115
10116 Example:
10117 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10118 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010119 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010120
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010121 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010122 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010123
10124 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010125 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010126 # protecting all our sites
10127 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010128 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10129 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010130 ...
10131 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10132
10133 backend http_dynamic
10134 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010135 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010136 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010137 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010138 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010139 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010140 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010142 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010143
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010144 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10145 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010146
10147
10148tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10149 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010151 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010152 Arguments :
10153 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10154 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10155 as explained at the top of this document.
10156
10157 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10158 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10159 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10160 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10161 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10162
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010163 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10164 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10165 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10166 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10167
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010168 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10169 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010170 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010171 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010172 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10173 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10174 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10175 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010176
10177 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10178 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10179 it pass through unaffected.
10180
10181 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10182 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10183 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010184 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010185 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10186 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010187 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10188 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10189 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010190
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010191 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010192 "timeout client".
10193
10194
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010195tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10196 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10198 no | no | yes | yes
10199 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010200 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10201 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010202
10203 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10204
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010205 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010206 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10207 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010208 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10209 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010210
10211 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10212
10213 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10214 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10215 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10216 inserted.
10217
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010218 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010219 - accept :
10220 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10221 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10222 the rules evaluation.
10223
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010224 - close :
10225 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10226 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10227 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10228 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10229 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10230 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010231 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010232 protocols.
10233
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010234 - reject :
10235 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10236 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010237 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010238
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010239 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10240 Sets a variable.
10241
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010242 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10243 Unsets a variable.
10244
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010245 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10246 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10247 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10248 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10249
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010250 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10251 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10252 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10253 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10254
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010255 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10256 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10257 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10258 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10259 continues.
10260
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010261 - "silent-drop" :
10262 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010263 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010264 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10265 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10266 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10267 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10268 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010269 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10270 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010271 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10272 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010273 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010274 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10275 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10276 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10277 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10278
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010279 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10280 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10281
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010282 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10283 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10284 for changing the default action to a reject.
10285
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010286 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10287 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10288 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10289 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010290 period.
10291
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010292 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10293 declared inline.
10294
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010295 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10296 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010297 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010298 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10299 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010300 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010301 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010302 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010303 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10304 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010305 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010306 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10307 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010308
10309 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10310 followed by some converters.
10311
10312 Example:
10313
10314 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10315
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010316 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10317 <var-name>.
10318
10319 Example:
10320
10321 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10322
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010323 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10324 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10325 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10326 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10327 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10328
10329 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10330
10331 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10332
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010333 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10334
10335 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10336
10337
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010338tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10339 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10341 no | yes | yes | no
10342 Arguments :
10343 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10344 below.
10345
10346 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10347
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010348 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010349 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10350 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10351 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10352 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10353 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10354 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10355 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010356 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010357 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10358 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10359 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10360 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10361 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10362 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10363 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10364 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10365 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10366 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10367 instead.
10368
10369 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10370 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10371 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10372 rules which may be inserted.
10373
10374 Several types of actions are supported :
10375 - accept : the request is accepted
10376 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10377 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10378 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010379 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010380 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10381 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010382 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010383 - silent-drop
10384
10385 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10386 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10387 sections for a complete description.
10388
10389 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10390 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10391 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10392
10393 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10394 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10395 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10396 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10397 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10398
10399 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10400 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10401
10402 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10403 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10404 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10405
10406 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10407 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10408 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10409
10410 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10411 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10412 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10413
10414 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10415 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10416 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10417
10418 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10419
10420 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10421
10422
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010423tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10424 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10426 no | no | yes | yes
10427 Arguments :
10428 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10429 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10430 as explained at the top of this document.
10431
10432 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10433
10434
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010435timeout check <timeout>
10436 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10437 established.
10438
10439 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10440 yes | no | yes | yes
10441 Arguments:
10442 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10443 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10444 as explained at the top of this document.
10445
10446 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10447 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010448 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010449 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010450 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10451 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10452 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010453
10454 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10455 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10456
10457 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10458 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010459 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010460
10461 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10462 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10463 forget about it.
10464
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010465 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10466 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010467
10468
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010469timeout client <timeout>
10470timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10471 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10473 yes | yes | yes | no
10474 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010475 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010476 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10477 as explained at the top of this document.
10478
10479 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10480 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10481 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010482 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10483 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10484 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10485 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010486 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10487 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10488 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010489 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010490 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010491 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10492 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010493 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10494 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010495
10496 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10497 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10498 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10499 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10500 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10501 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10502
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010503 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010504
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010505 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10506 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10507 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10508
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010509 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10510 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010511
10512
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010513timeout client-fin <timeout>
10514 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10516 yes | yes | yes | no
10517 Arguments :
10518 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10519 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10520 as explained at the top of this document.
10521
10522 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10523 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10524 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10525 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10526 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10527 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10528 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010529 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10530 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10531 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010532
10533 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10534 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10535 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10536
10537 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10538
10539
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010540timeout connect <timeout>
10541timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10542 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10544 yes | no | yes | yes
10545 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010546 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010547 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10548 as explained at the top of this document.
10549
10550 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010551 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010552 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010553 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010554 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10555 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010556
10557 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10558 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10559 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10560 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10561 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10562 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10563
10564 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10565 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10566 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10567
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010568 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10569 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010570
10571
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010572timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10573 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10575 yes | yes | yes | yes
10576 Arguments :
10577 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10578 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10579 as explained at the top of this document.
10580
10581 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10582 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10583 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10584 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10585 once the request has started to present itself.
10586
10587 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10588 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10589 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10590 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10591 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10592
10593 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10594 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10595 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10596 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10597
10598 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10599 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010600 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010601 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10602 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010603 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010604
10605 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10606 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10607 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10608 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10609
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010610 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10611 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010612 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10613
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010614 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10615
10616
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010617timeout http-request <timeout>
10618 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010620 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010621 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010622 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010623 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10624 as explained at the top of this document.
10625
10626 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10627 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10628 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10629 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10630 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10631 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10632 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010633 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10634 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10635 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10636 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010637 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010638 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10639 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010640
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010641 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10642 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10643 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10644 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10645 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010646 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010647
10648 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10649 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010650 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010651 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10652 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10653
10654 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010655 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10656 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10657 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010658
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010659 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010660 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010661
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010662
10663timeout queue <timeout>
10664 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10666 yes | no | yes | yes
10667 Arguments :
10668 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10669 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10670 as explained at the top of this document.
10671
10672 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10673 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10674 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10675 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10676 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10677
10678 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10679 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10680 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10681 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10682
10683 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10684
10685
10686timeout server <timeout>
10687timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10688 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10690 yes | no | yes | yes
10691 Arguments :
10692 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10693 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10694 as explained at the top of this document.
10695
10696 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10697 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10698 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10699 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10700 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10701 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10702 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10703
10704 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10705 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10706 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10707 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10708 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010709 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010710 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010711 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10712 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010713 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10714 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010715
10716 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10717 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10718 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10719 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10720 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10721 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10722
10723 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10724 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10725 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10726
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010727 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010728
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010729
10730timeout server-fin <timeout>
10731 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10733 yes | no | yes | yes
10734 Arguments :
10735 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10736 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10737 as explained at the top of this document.
10738
10739 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10740 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10741 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10742 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10743 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10744 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10745 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10746 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10747 situations, it should not be needed.
10748
10749 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10750 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10751 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10752
10753 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10754
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010755
10756timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010757 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10759 yes | yes | yes | yes
10760 Arguments :
10761 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10762 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10763 as explained at the top of this document.
10764
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010765 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10766 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10767 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10768 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010769
10770 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10771 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10772 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10773 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010774 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010775
10776 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10777
10778
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010779timeout tunnel <timeout>
10780 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10782 yes | no | yes | yes
10783 Arguments :
10784 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10785 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10786 as explained at the top of this document.
10787
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010788 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010789 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10790 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10791 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010792 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10793 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010794 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10795 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10796 specified.
10797
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010798 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10799 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10800 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10801 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10802 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10803 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10804 state.
10805
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010806 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10807 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10808 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10809 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010810 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010811
10812 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10813 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10814 forget about it.
10815
10816 Example :
10817 defaults http
10818 option http-server-close
10819 timeout connect 5s
10820 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010821 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010822 timeout server 30s
10823 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10824
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010825 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010826
10827
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010828transparent (deprecated)
10829 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010831 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010832 Arguments : none
10833
10834 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10835 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10836 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10837 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10838 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10839 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10840 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10841 appropriate server.
10842
10843 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10844
10845 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10846 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10847
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010848 See also: "option transparent"
10849
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010850unique-id-format <string>
10851 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10853 yes | yes | yes | no
10854 Arguments :
10855 <string> is a log-format string.
10856
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010857 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10858 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10859 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10860 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010861
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010862 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10863 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10864 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10865 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10866 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10867 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10868 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10869 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010870
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010871 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10872 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010873
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010874 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010875
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010876 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010877
10878 will generate:
10879
10880 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10881
10882 See also: "unique-id-header"
10883
10884unique-id-header <name>
10885 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10887 yes | yes | yes | no
10888 Arguments :
10889 <name> is the name of the header.
10890
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010891 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10892 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010893
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010894 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010895
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010896 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010897 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10898
10899 will generate:
10900
10901 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10902
10903 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010904
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010905use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010906 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10908 no | yes | yes | no
10909 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010910 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10911 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010912
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010913 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10914 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010915
10916 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10917 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10918 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010919 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010920 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010921 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10922 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010923
10924 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10925 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10926 assign the backend.
10927
10928 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10929 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10930 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10931 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10932 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10933 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10934
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010935 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010936 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010937 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10938 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10939 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10940
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010941 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10942 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10943 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10944 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10945 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10946 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10947 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10948 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10949 cannot be forced from the request.
10950
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010951 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010952 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10953 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10954
10955 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10956 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010957
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010958
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010959use-server <server> if <condition>
10960use-server <server> unless <condition>
10961 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10963 no | no | yes | yes
10964 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010965 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010966
10967 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10968
10969 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10970 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10971 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10972
10973 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10974 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10975 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10976 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10977 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10978 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10979 matches will assign the server.
10980
10981 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10982 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10983 with the next rules until one matches.
10984
10985 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10986 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10987 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10988 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10989
10990 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10991 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10992 stripped.
10993
10994 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10995 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10996 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10997 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10998
10999 Example :
11000 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11001 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11002 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11003 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11004 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11005 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011006 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011007 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11008 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11009
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011010 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011011
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011012
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100110135. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011014--------------------------
11015
11016The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11017depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11018settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11019written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11020described in this section.
11021
11022
110235.1. Bind options
11024-----------------
11025
11026The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11027as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11028no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11029parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11030while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11031provided immediately after the setting name.
11032
11033The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11034
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011035accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11036 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11037 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11038 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11039 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11040 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11041 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11042 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11043 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11044 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011045 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11046 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11047 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011048
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011049accept-proxy
11050 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011051 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11052 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011053 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11054 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11055 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11056 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011057 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011058 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11059 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011060 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11061 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011062
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011063allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011064 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011065 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
11066 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
11067 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11068 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011069
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011070alpn <protocols>
11071 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11072 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11073 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11074 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11075 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011076 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11077 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11078 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11079 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11080 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11081 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11082 preference, like below :
11083
11084 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011085
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011086backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011087 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011088 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11089
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011090curves <curves>
11091 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11092 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11093 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11094 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11095 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11096 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11097
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011098ecdhe <named curve>
11099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011100 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11101 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011102
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011103ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011104 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11105 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11106 client's certificate.
11107
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011108ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11109 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11110 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11111 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11112 error is ignored.
11113
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011114ca-sign-file <cafile>
11115 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11116 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11117 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11118 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11119 'generate-certificates' for details.
11120
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011121ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11123 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11124 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11125 'generate-certificates' for details.
11126
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011127ciphers <ciphers>
11128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11129 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011130 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011131 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011132 information and recommendations see e.g.
11133 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11134 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11135 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11136
11137ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11138 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11139 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11140 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11141 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011142 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11143 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011144
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011145crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11147 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11148 to verify client's certificate.
11149
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011150crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011151 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11152 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11153 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11154 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11155 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11156 file.
11157
11158 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11159 are loaded.
11160
11161 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011162 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011163 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11164 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11165 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11166 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011167 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11168 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011169 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011170
11171 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11172 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11173 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11174 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011175 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11176 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011177
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011178 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011179
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011180 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011181 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011182 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11183 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011184 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11185 clients).
11186
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011187 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11188 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11189 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11190 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11191 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11192 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11193 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11194 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11195 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11196 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11197 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11198 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11199 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11200
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011201 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11202 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11203 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11204 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11205 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11206
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011207 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11208 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11209 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11210 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011211
11212 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11213 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11214 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11215 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11216 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11217 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11218 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11219 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11220 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11221
11222 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11223
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011224 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011225 a cert bundle.
11226
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011227 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011228 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11229 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11230 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11231 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11232 provide multi-cert support.
11233
11234 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11235
11236 Filename | CN | SAN
11237 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11238 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011239 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011240 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11241 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11242
11243 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11244 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11245 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11246 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011247 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11248 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11249 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011250
11251 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11252 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11253
11254 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11255 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11256 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11257
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011258crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011259 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011260 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011261 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011262 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011263
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011264crt-list <file>
11265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011266 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11267 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011268
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011269 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11270
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011271 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11272 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011273 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011274 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011275
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011276 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11277 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11278 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11279 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11280 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11281 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11282 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11283 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011284
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011285 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011286 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011287 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11288 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11289 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011290
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011291 crt-list file example:
11292 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011293 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011294 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011295 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011296
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011297defer-accept
11298 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11299 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11300 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011301 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011302 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11303 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11304 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11305 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11306 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11307 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11308 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11309
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011310expose-fd listeners
11311 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11312 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011313 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11314 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011315 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011316
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011317force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011318 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011319 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011320 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011321 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011322
11323force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011324 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011325 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011326 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011327
11328force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011329 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011330 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011331 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011332
11333force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011334 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011335 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011336 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011337
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011338force-tlsv13
11339 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11340 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011341 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011342
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011343generate-certificates
11344 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11345 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11346 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11347 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11348 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11349 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11350 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11351 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11352 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11353 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11354 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11355
11356 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11357 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011358 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011359 certificate is used many times.
11360
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011361gid <gid>
11362 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11363 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11364 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11365 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11366 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11367
11368group <group>
11369 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11370 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11371 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11372 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11373 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11374
11375id <id>
11376 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11377 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11378 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11379 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11380
11381interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011382 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11383 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11384 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11385 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11386 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11387 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011388 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11389 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11390 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11391 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11392 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11393 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011394
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011395level <level>
11396 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11397 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11398 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011399 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011400 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11401 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11402 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011403 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011404 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011405 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011406 all counters).
11407
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011408severity-output <format>
11409 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11410 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11411 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11412 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11413 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11414 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11415 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11416 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11417 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11418 rfc5424 convention.
11419
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011420maxconn <maxconn>
11421 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11422 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11423 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11424 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11425 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11426 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11427 eat all memory.
11428
11429mode <mode>
11430 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11431 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11432 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11433 UNIX sockets.
11434
11435mss <maxseg>
11436 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11437 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11438 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11439 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11440 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11441 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11442 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11443 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11444 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11445 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11446 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11447
11448name <name>
11449 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11450 page.
11451
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011452namespace <name>
11453 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11454 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11455 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11456 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11457
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011458nice <nice>
11459 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11460 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11461 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11462 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11463 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11464 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11465 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11466 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11467 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11468 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11469 one for an RDP socket.
11470
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011471no-ca-names
11472 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11473 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11474
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011475no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011476 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011477 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011478 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011479 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011480 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11481 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011482
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011483no-tls-tickets
11484 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11485 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11486 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011487 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11488 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011489
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011490no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011492 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011493 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011494 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011495 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11496 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011497
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011498no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011499 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011500 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011501 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011502 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011503 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11504 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011505
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011506no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011507 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011508 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011509 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011510 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011511 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11512 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011513
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011514no-tlsv13
11515 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11516 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11517 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11518 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011519 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11520 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011521
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011522npn <protocols>
11523 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11524 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11525 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11526 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011527 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011528 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11529 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11530 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11531 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11532 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011533
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011534prefer-client-ciphers
11535 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11536 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11537 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011538 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11539 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11540 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011541
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011542process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011543 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011544 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011545 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011546 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11547 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11548 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11549 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011550 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011551 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11552 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11553 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11554 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11555 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011556
11557 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11558
11559 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11560 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11561 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11562 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11563 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11564 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11565 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11566 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011567
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011568proto <name>
11569 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11570 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11571 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11572 in haproxy -vv.
11573 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11574 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011575 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011576 h2" on the bind line.
11577
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011578ssl
11579 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011580 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011581 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11582 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011583 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11584 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011585
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011586ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11587 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11588 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11589 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11590
11591ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11592 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11593 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11594 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11595
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011596strict-sni
11597 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11598 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11599 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11600 See the "crt" option for more information.
11601
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011602tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011603 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011604 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11605 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011606 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011607 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11608 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11609 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11610 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11611 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11612 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11613 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11614
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011615tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011616 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011617 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11618 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11619 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11620 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11621 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11622 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11623 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011624 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11625 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11626 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011627
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011628tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11629 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011630 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11631 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11632 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11633 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11634 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11635 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11636 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11637 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11638 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11639 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011640 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11641 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11642
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011643transparent
11644 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11645 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11646 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11647 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11648 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11649 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11650 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11651 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11652 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11653 so check for support with your vendor.
11654
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011655v4v6
11656 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11657 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11658 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11659 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011660 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011661
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011662v6only
11663 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11664 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11665 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011666 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11667 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011668
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011669uid <uid>
11670 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11671 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11672 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11673 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11674 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11675
11676user <user>
11677 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11678 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11679 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11680 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11681 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11682
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011683verify [none|optional|required]
11684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11685 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11686 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11687 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11688 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011689 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11690 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11691 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11692 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011693
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200116945.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011695------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011697The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11698which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11699arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11700settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11701after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11702Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11703address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011705 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011706 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011707
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011708Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11709keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11710
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011711The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011712
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011713addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011714 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011715 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11716 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11717 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11718 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11719 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011720
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011721agent-check
11722 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011723 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011724 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11725 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11726 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011727
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011728 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011729 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011730 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11731 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11732 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011733
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011734 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11735 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11736 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11737 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11738 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011739
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011740 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011741 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011742
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011743 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11744 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11745 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011746
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011747 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11748 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11749 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011750
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011751 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11752 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11753 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11754 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11755 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011756 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011757 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011758
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011759 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11760 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011761
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011762 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11763 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11764 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11765 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11766 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11767 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11768 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11769 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11770 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011771
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011772 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11773 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011774 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11775 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11776 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011777 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011778
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011779 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011780 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011781
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011782agent-send <string>
11783 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11784 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11785 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11786 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11787 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11788
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011789agent-inter <delay>
11790 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11791 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11792
11793 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11794 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11795 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11796 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11797 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11798 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11799 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11800 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11801 of backends use the same servers.
11802
11803 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11804
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011805agent-addr <addr>
11806 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11807
11808 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11809 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11810 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11811 hostname, it will be resolved.
11812
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011813agent-port <port>
11814 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11815
11816 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11817
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011818allow-0rtt
11819 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011820 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11821 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011822
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011823alpn <protocols>
11824 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11825 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11826 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11827 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11828 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11829 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11830 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11831 now obsolete NPN extension.
11832 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11833 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11834
11835 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11836
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011837backup
11838 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11839 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11840 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11841 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011842 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11843 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011844
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011845ca-file <cafile>
11846 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11847 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11848 server's certificate.
11849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011850check
11851 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011852 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11853 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11854 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11855 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11856 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11857 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11858 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011859 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11860 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011861 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11862 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011863
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011864check-send-proxy
11865 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11866 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11867 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11868 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11869 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11870 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11871 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11872
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011873check-alpn <protocols>
11874 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11875 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11876 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11877
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011878check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011879 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011880 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11881 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011882
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011883check-ssl
11884 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11885 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11886 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11887 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011888 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011889 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11890 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011891 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011892 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11893 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011894
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011895ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011896 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11897 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11898 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011899 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11900 information and recommendations see e.g.
11901 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11902 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11903 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011904
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011905ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11906 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11907 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11908 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11909 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011910 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11911 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11912 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011914cookie <value>
11915 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11916 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11917 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11918 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11919 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11920 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11921 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11922
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011923crl-file <crlfile>
11924 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11925 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11926 to verify server's certificate.
11927
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011928crt <cert>
11929 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11930 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11931 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11932 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11933 certificate request.
11934
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011935disabled
11936 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11937 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11938 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11939 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11940 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011941 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011942
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011943enabled
11944 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11945 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11946 default value.
11947 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11948 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011950error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011951 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11952 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11953 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011954
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011955 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011957fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011958 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11959 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11960 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11961
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011962force-sslv3
11963 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11964 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011965 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011966 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011967
11968force-tlsv10
11969 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011970 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011971 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011972
11973force-tlsv11
11974 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011975 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011976 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011977
11978force-tlsv12
11979 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011980 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011981 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011982
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011983force-tlsv13
11984 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11985 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011986 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011988id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011989 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11990 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11991 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011992
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011993init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11994 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11995 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011996 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011997 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11998 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11999 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12000 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12001 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12002 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12003 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12004 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12005 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012006 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012007 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12008 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12009 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12010 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12011 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12012 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012013 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012014
12015 Example:
12016 defaults
12017 # never fail on address resolution
12018 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012020inter <delay>
12021fastinter <delay>
12022downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012023 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12024 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12025 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12026 between checks depending on the server state :
12027
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012028 Server state | Interval used
12029 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12030 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12031 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12032 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12033 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12034 or yet unchecked. |
12035 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12036 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12037 | "inter" otherwise.
12038 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012040 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12041 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12042 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12043 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012044 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12045 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12046 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12047 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12048 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012050maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012051 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12052 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
12053 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
12054 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
12055 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12056 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12057 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12058 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12059
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012060maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012061 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12062 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12063 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12064 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12065 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12066 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12067 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12068
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012069max-reuse <count>
12070 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12071 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12072 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12073 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12074 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12075 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12076 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12077 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012079minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012080 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12081 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12082 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12083 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12084 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12085 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012086 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012087 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012088
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012089namespace <name>
12090 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12091 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12092 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12093 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12094
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012095no-agent-check
12096 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12097 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12098 default value.
12099 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12100 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12101
12102no-backup
12103 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12104 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12105 default value.
12106 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12107 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12108
12109no-check
12110 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12111 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12112 default value.
12113 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12114 "default-server" "check" setting.
12115
12116no-check-ssl
12117 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12118 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12119 default value.
12120 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12121 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12122
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012123no-send-proxy
12124 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12125 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12126 default value.
12127 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12128 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12129
12130no-send-proxy-v2
12131 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12132 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12133 default value.
12134 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12135 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12136
12137no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12138 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12139 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12140 default value.
12141 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12142 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12143
12144no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12145 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12146 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12147 default value.
12148 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12149 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12150
12151no-ssl
12152 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12153 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12154 default value.
12155 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12156 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12157
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012158no-ssl-reuse
12159 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12160 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12161 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12162 and for paranoid users.
12163
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012164no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012165 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12166 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012167 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012168
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012169 Supported in default-server: No
12170
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012171no-tls-tickets
12172 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12173 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12174 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012175 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12176 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012177 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012178
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012179no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012180 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012181 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12182 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012183 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12184 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012185 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012186
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012187 Supported in default-server: No
12188
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012189no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012190 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012191 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12192 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012193 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12194 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012195 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012196
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012197 Supported in default-server: No
12198
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012199no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012200 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012201 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12202 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012203 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12204 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012205 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012206
12207 Supported in default-server: No
12208
12209no-tlsv13
12210 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12211 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12212 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12213 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12214 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012215 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012216
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012217 Supported in default-server: No
12218
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012219no-verifyhost
12220 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12221 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12222 default value.
12223 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12224 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012225
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012226non-stick
12227 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12228 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12229 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12230
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012231npn <protocols>
12232 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12233 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12234 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12235 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12236 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12237 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12238 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12239
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012240observe <mode>
12241 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12242 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12243 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12244 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12245 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12246 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012247 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012248
12249 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012251on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012252 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12253 Currently, four modes are available:
12254 - fastinter: force fastinter
12255 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12256 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12257 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12258 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12259
12260 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12261
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012262on-marked-down <action>
12263 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12264 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012265 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12266 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12267 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12268 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12269 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12270 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12271 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12272 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012273
12274 Actions are disabled by default
12275
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012276on-marked-up <action>
12277 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12278 Currently one action is available:
12279 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12280 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12281 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12282 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012283 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12284 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012285 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12286 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12287
12288 Actions are disabled by default
12289
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012290pool-max-conn <max>
12291 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12292 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12293 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12294 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12295 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12296 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12297
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012298pool-purge-delay <delay>
12299 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012300 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
12301 The default is 1s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012303port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012304 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12305 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12306 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12307 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12308 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12309 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12310
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012311proto <name>
12312
12313 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12314 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12315 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12316 reported in haproxy -vv.
12317 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12318 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012320redir <prefix>
12321 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12322 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12323 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12324 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12325 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12326 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12327 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12328 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012329 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012330 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012331 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12332 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12333 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12334 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12335
12336 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012338rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012339 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12340 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12341 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12342
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012343resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12344 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12345 server.
12346
12347 Available options:
12348
12349 * allow-dup-ip
12350 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12351 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12352 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12353 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12354 For such case, simply enable this option.
12355 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12356
12357 * prevent-dup-ip
12358 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12359 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12360 same fqdn.
12361 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12362
12363 Example:
12364 backend b_myapp
12365 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12366 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12367 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12368
12369 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12370 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12371 it
12372 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12373 different address
12374
12375 Default value: not set
12376
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012377resolve-prefer <family>
12378 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12379 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12380 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12381 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12382
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012383 Default value: ipv6
12384
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012385 Example:
12386
12387 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012388
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012389resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12390 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12391 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012392 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012393 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12394 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012395 configured network, another address is selected.
12396
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012397 Example:
12398
12399 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012400
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012401resolvers <id>
12402 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12403 hostname.
12404
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012405 Example:
12406
12407 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012408
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012409 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012410
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012411send-proxy
12412 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12413 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12414 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12415 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012416 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12417 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12418 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12419 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12420 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12421 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12422 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12423 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12424 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12425 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012426 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12427 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012428
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012429send-proxy-v2
12430 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12431 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12432 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12433 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012434 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12435 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12436 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12437 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012438
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012439proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12440 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12441 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012442 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12443 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012444 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12445 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012446 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012447
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012448send-proxy-v2-ssl
12449 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12450 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12451 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12452 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12453 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12454 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12455 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012456 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12457 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012458
12459send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12460 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12461 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12462 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12463 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12464 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12465 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12466 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12467 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012468 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12469 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012470
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012471slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012472 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12473 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12474 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12475 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12476 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12477 parameters :
12478
12479 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12480 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12481
12482 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12483 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12484 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12485 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12486
12487 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12488 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12489 seen as failed.
12490
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012491sni <expression>
12492 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12493 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12494 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12495 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012496 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12497 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012498 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012499 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12500 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012501
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012502source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012503source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012504source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012505 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12506 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12507 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12508 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12509
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012510 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12511 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12512 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12513 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12514 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12515 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12516 server.
12517
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012518 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12519 specifying the source address without port(s).
12520
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012521ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012522 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12523 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12524 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12525 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12526 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12527 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012528 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12529 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012530
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012531ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12532 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12533 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12534 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12535
12536ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12537 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12538 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12539 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12540
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012541ssl-reuse
12542 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12543 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12544 default value.
12545 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12546 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12547
12548stick
12549 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12550 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12551 default value.
12552 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12553 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012554
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012555tcp-ut <delay>
12556 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12557 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12558 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012559 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012560 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12561 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12562 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12563 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12564 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12565 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12566 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12567 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12568 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12569
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012570tfo
12571 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12572 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12573 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12574 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12575 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
12576 won't be able to retry the connection on failure.
12577
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012578track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012579 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12580 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12581 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12582 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012583 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12584
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012585tls-tickets
12586 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12587 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12588 default value.
12589 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12590 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012591
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012592verify [none|required]
12593 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012594 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012595 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12596 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012597 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012598 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12599 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12600 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12601 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12602 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12603 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12604 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12605 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012606
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012607verifyhost <hostname>
12608 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012609 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12610 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12611 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12612 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12613 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12614 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12615 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12616 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012617
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012618weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012619 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12620 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12621 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012622 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12623 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12624 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12625 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12626 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12627 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012628
12629
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126305.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12631-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012632
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012633HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12634using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12635configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012636This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12637can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12638workload.
12639This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12640resolution at run time.
12641Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12642carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12643
12644
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126455.3.1. Global overview
12646----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012647
12648As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12649different steps of the process life:
12650
12651 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12652 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12653 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12654
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012655 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12656 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012657
12658A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12659 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12660 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12661 resolution to know this new IP.
12662
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012663When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012664HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012665SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12666from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12667will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12668will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012669
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012670A few things important to notice:
12671 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12672 first valid response.
12673
12674 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12675 servers return an error.
12676
12677
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126785.3.2. The resolvers section
12679----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012680
12681This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012682HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12683contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012684
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012685When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12686uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12687is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12688answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12689
12690When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012691used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012692
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012693 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12694 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12695 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012696
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012697 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12698 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012699
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012700 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12701 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12702 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012703
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012704For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12705following scenarios are possible:
12706
12707 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12708 ignored
12709
12710 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12711 applied
12712
12713 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12714 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12715
12716 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12717 retries the query with a new type
12718
12719 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12720 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012721
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012722As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12723a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012724<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012725
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012726
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012727resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012728 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012729
12730A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12731
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012732accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012733 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012734 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012735 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12736 by RFC 6891)
12737
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012738 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12739
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012740nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12741 DNS server description:
12742 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12743 <ip> : IP address of the server
12744 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12745
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012746parse-resolv-conf
12747 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12748 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12749 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12750
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012751hold <status> <period>
12752 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12753 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012754 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012755 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012756 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12757 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12758 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12759
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012760 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012761
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012762resolve_retries <nb>
12763 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12764 giving up.
12765 Default value: 3
12766
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012767 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12768 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12769 type.
12770
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012771timeout <event> <time>
12772 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12773 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12774 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012775 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12776 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012777 Default value: 1s
12778 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012779 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012780 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012781 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12782 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12783
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012784 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012785
12786 resolvers mydns
12787 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12788 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012789 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012790 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012791 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012792 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012793 hold other 30s
12794 hold refused 30s
12795 hold nx 30s
12796 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012797 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012798 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012799
12800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128016. HTTP header manipulation
12802---------------------------
12803
12804In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12805response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12806request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12807which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012808against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012809
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012810If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12811to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12812but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12813HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12814stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12815because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12816a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12817still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012819This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12820in section 4.2 :
12821
12822 - reqadd <string>
12823 - reqallow <search>
12824 - reqiallow <search>
12825 - reqdel <search>
12826 - reqidel <search>
12827 - reqdeny <search>
12828 - reqideny <search>
12829 - reqpass <search>
12830 - reqipass <search>
12831 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12832 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12833 - reqtarpit <search>
12834 - reqitarpit <search>
12835 - rspadd <string>
12836 - rspdel <search>
12837 - rspidel <search>
12838 - rspdeny <search>
12839 - rspideny <search>
12840 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12841 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12842
12843With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12844is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12845parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12846prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12847Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12848
12849 \t for a tab
12850 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12851 \n for a new line (LF)
12852 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12853 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12854 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12855 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12856 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12857
12858The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12859portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12860above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12861regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
128629 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12863is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12864
12865The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12866after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12867
12868Notes related to these keywords :
12869---------------------------------
12870 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12871 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12872 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12873
12874 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12875 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12876 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12877
12878 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12879 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12880 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12881 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12882 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12883
12884 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12885 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12886 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12887 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12888 useless headers before adding new ones.
12889
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012890 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012891 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12892
12893 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12894 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12895 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12896
12897 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12898 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012899 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012900
12901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129027. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12903----------------------------------
12904
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012905HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012906client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12907The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12908these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12909but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12910data called patterns.
12911
12912
129137.1. ACL basics
12914---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012915
12916The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12917content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12918from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12919simple :
12920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012921 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012922 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012923 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12924 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012926The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12927adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012928
12929In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012931 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012932
12933This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12934Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12935and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012936an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12937conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12938as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12939are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012940
12941ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12942'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12943which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12944
12945There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12946performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012948The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12949specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12950this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012951methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12952ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012953
12954Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12955 - boolean
12956 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12957 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12958 - string
12959 - data block
12960
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012961Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12962converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12963would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12964The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12965which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12966
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012967Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12968keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12969fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12970which are summarized in the table below :
12971
12972 +---------------------+-----------------+
12973 | Sample or converter | Default |
12974 | output type | matching method |
12975 +---------------------+-----------------+
12976 | boolean | bool |
12977 +---------------------+-----------------+
12978 | integer | int |
12979 +---------------------+-----------------+
12980 | ip | ip |
12981 +---------------------+-----------------+
12982 | string | str |
12983 +---------------------+-----------------+
12984 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12985 +---------------------+-----------------+
12986
12987Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12988matching method, see below.
12989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012990The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12991 - boolean
12992 - integer or integer range
12993 - IP address / network
12994 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12995 - regular expression
12996 - hex block
12997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012998The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12999
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013000 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13001 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013002 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013003 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013004 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013005 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013006 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013008The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13009read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13010if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13011lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13012will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13013beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13014a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13015lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13016exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13017
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013018The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13019parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13020ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13021a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13022check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13023
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013024The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13025socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13026file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013028Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13029loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13030
13031 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13032
13033In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13034the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13035case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13036as well.
13037
13038The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13039sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13040do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13041methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13042is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013043obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013044followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13045default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13046that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13047string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13048
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013049The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13050By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13051string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13052resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13053server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
13054waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
13055flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13056function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013058There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13059sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13060be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013061
13062 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13063 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013064 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13065 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13066 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13067 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013068
13069 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13070 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013071 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013072
13073 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013074 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013075
13076 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013077 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013078
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013079 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013080 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13081
13082 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13083 binary or string samples.
13084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013085 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13086 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013088 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13089 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13090 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013092 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13093 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013095 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13096 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013098 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13099 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013101 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13102 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013103 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013105 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13106 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13107 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013108
13109For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13110request, it is possible to do :
13111
13112 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13113
13114In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13115buffer, one would use the following acl :
13116
13117 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13118
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013119On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13120possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13121
13122 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013124All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13125criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13126method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13127to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13128criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13129the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013131If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013132the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13133For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013135 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13136 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13137 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13138 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013139
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013140
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013141The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13142types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13143combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13144brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13145default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013147 +-------------------------------------------------+
13148 | Input sample type |
13149 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013150 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013151 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13152 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13153 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013154 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013155 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013156 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013157 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013158 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013159 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013160 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013161 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013162 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013163 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013164 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013165 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013166 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013167 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013168 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013169 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013170 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013171 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013172 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013173 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013174 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013175 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13176 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13177 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013178
13179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131807.1.1. Matching booleans
13181------------------------
13182
13183In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13184Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13185When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13186that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13187
13188Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13189return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13190"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13191
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131937.1.2. Matching integers
13194------------------------
13195
13196Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13197enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13198to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13199
13200Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13201matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13202lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013203
13204For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13205unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13206representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13207
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013208As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13209two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13210instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13211ranges and operators.
13212
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013213For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013214operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13215Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13216of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013217
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013218Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013219
13220 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13221 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13222 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13223 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13224 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13225
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013226For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013227
13228 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13229
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013230This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13231
13232 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13233
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132357.1.3. Matching strings
13236-----------------------
13237
13238String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13239different forms :
13240
13241 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013242 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013243
13244 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013245 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013246
13247 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13248 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13249
13250 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13251 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13252
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013253 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013254 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13255 matches.
13256
13257 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13258 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13259 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013260
13261String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13262exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13263characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13264string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13265to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013266before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013267
13268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132697.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13270---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013271
13272Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13273they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13274possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13275passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13276the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013277the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13278match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013279
13280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13282-------------------------------------
13283
13284It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13285not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13286a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13287to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13288digits may be used upper or lower case.
13289
13290Example :
13291 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13292 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13293
13294
132957.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13296---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013297
13298IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13299netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13300within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013301host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013302difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13303at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13304does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13305parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013306
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013307The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13308abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13309
13310 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13311 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13312 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13313 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13314 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13315 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13316 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13317 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13318
13319Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13320192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13321
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013322IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13323Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13324trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13325IPv6 patterns.
13326
13327HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13328following situations :
13329 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13330 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13331 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13332 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13333 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13334 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13335 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13336 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13337 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13338 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013340
133417.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13342----------------------------------
13343
13344Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13345combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13346
13347 - AND (implicit)
13348 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13349 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013351A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013353 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013355Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13356indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013358For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13359"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13360requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13361is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13362
13363 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013364 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13365 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13366 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013367
13368To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13369and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13370
13371 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13372 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13373 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13374 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13375
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013376 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013377 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13378 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13379 use_backend www if host_www
13380
13381It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13382expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13383be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13384the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13385
13386 The following rule :
13387
13388 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013389 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013390
13391 Can also be written that way :
13392
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013393 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013394
13395It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13396to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13397simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13398sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13399good use is the following :
13400
13401 With named ACLs :
13402
13403 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13404 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13405 monitor fail if site_dead
13406
13407 With anonymous ACLs :
13408
13409 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13410
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013411See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13412keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013413
13414
134157.3. Fetching samples
13416---------------------
13417
13418Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13419against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13420sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13421ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13422of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13423available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13424
13425This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13426Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13427compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13428deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13429
13430The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13431matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13432method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13433indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13434
13435As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13436when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13437mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13438the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13439ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13440
13441Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13442multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13443when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013444incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13445are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013446is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13447all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13448
13449Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13450 - name
13451 - name(arg1)
13452 - name(arg1,arg2)
13453
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013454
134557.3.1. Converters
13456-----------------
13457
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013458Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13459of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13460is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13461was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013462has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013463unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13464
13465These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13466sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13467the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013468support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013469
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013470A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13471support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13472supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13473(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13474bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013476The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013477
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001347851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13479 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13480 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13481 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13482 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13483 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13484
13485 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013486 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13487 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013488 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13489 frontend http-in
13490 bind *:8081
13491 default_backend servers
13492 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13493 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13494
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013495add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013496 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013497 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013498 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13499 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013500 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013501 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13502 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13503 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13504 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013505 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013506 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013507
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013508aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13509 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13510 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13511 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13512 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13513 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13514 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13515
13516 Example:
13517 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13518 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13519
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013520and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013521 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013522 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013523 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13524 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013525 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013526 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13527 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13528 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13529 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013530 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013531 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013532
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013533b64dec
13534 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13535 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13536
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013537base64
13538 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013539 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013540 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13541
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013542bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013543 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013544 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013545 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013546 presence of a flag).
13547
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013548bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13549 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13550 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013551 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013552
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013553concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13554 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13555 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13556 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13557 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13558 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13559 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13560 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13561 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13562 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13563 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13564 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13565 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13566 delimitors.
13567
13568 Example:
13569 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13570 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13571 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13572 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13573
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013574cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013575 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13576 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013577
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013578crc32([<avalanche>])
13579 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13580 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13581 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13582 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13583 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13584 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13585 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13586 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13587 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13588 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013589 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13590
13591crc32c([<avalanche>])
13592 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13593 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13594 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13595 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13596 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13597 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13598 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13599 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013600
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013601da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013602 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13603 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13604 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13605 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013606 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013607 configuration language.
13608
13609 Example:
13610 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013611 bind *:8881
13612 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013613 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013614
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013615debug
13616 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13617 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13618 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13619
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013620div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013621 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13622 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013623 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013624 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13625 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013626 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013627 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13628 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13629 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13630 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013631 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013632 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013633
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013634djb2([<avalanche>])
13635 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13636 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13637 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13638 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13639 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13640 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13641 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013642 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13643 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013644
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013645even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013646 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013647 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13648
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013649field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13650 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13651 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13652 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13653 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13654 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13655 fields.
13656
13657 Example :
13658 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13659 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13660 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13661 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13662 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013663
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013664hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013665 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013666 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013667 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013668 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013669
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013670hex2i
13671 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13672 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13673
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013674http_date([<offset>])
13675 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13676 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13677 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13678 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13679 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13680 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013681
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013682in_table(<table>)
13683 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13684 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13685 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013686 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013687 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13688
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013689ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13690 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013691 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013692 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13693 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13694 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13695 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13696 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013697
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013698json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013699 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013700 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013701 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013702 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13703 of errors:
13704 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13705 bytes, ...)
13706 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13707 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13708
13709 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13710 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13711 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13712 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13713 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13714 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013715 - "ascii" : never fails;
13716 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13717 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013718 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013719 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013720 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13721 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13722
13723 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013724 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013725
13726 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013727 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013728 capture request header user-agent len 150
13729 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013730
13731 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13732 GET / HTTP/1.0
13733 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13734
13735 Output log:
13736 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13737
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013738language(<value>[,<default>])
13739 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13740 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13741 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13742 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13743 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13744 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13745 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13746 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13747 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013748 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013749 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13750 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013751
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013752 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013753
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013754 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13755 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013756
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013757 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13758 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13759 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13760 use_backend spanish if es
13761 use_backend french if fr
13762 use_backend english if en
13763 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013764
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013765length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013766 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13767 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13768 type. The result is of type integer.
13769
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013770lower
13771 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13772 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13773 type. The result is of type string.
13774
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013775ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13776 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13777 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13778 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13779 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13780 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13781 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13782
13783 Example :
13784
13785 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013786 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013787 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13788
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013789map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13790map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13791map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13792 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13793 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13794 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13795 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13796 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13797 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13798 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13799 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013800
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013801 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13802 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13803 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013804
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013805 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013806 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013807
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013808 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13809 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13810 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13811 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013812 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13813 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013814 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13815 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13816 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13817 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13818 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13819 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13820 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13821 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013822 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13823 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13824 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013825 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13826 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13827 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13828 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13829 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013830
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013831 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13832 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13833 the corresponding match text.
13834
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013835 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13836 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13837 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13838 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13839 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013840
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013841 Example :
13842
13843 # this is a comment and is ignored
13844 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13845 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13846 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13847 | | | `---------- value
13848 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13849 | `---------------------------- key
13850 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13851
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013852mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013853 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13854 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013855 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013856 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013857 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013858 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13859 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13860 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13861 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013862 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013863 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013864
13865mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013866 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013867 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13868 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013869 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013870 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013871 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013872 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13873 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13874 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13875 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013876 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013877 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013878
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013879nbsrv
13880 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13881 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13882 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13883 map lookup.
13884
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013885neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013886 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13887 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13888 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13889 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013890
13891not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013892 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013893 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013894 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013895 absence of a flag).
13896
13897odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013898 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013899 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13900
13901or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013902 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013903 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013904 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13905 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013906 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013907 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13908 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13909 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13910 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013911 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013912 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013913
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013914protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13915 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13916 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13917 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13918 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13919 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13920 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13921 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13922 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13923 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13924 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13925 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13926
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013927regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013928 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13929 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13930 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13931 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13932 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13933 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13934 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13935 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13936 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13937 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013938 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13939 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13940 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13941 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013942
13943 Example :
13944
13945 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13946 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13947 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13948 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13949
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013950capture-req(<id>)
13951 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13952 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13953
13954 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013955 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13956 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013957
13958capture-res(<id>)
13959 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13960 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13961
13962 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013963 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13964 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013965
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013966sdbm([<avalanche>])
13967 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13968 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13969 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13970 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13971 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13972 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13973 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013974 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13975 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013976
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013977set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013978 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13979 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13980 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013981 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013982 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13983 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013984 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013985 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13986 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013987 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013988 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013989
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013990sha1
13991 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13992 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13993
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013994strcmp(<var>)
13995 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13996 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13997 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13998 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13999 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14000 shorter).
14001
14002 Example :
14003
14004 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14005 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14006 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14007
14008
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014009sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014010 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14011 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014012 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014013 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14014 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014015 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014016 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14017 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014018 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014019 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14020 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014021 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014022 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014023
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014024table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14025 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14026 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14027 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14028 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14029 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14030 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14031
14032
14033table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14034 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14035 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14036 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14037 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14038 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14039 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14040
14041table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14042 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14043 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014044 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014045 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14046 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14047
14048table_conn_cur(<table>)
14049 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14050 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14051 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14052 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14053 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14054
14055table_conn_rate(<table>)
14056 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14057 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14058 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14059 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14060 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14061
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014062table_gpt0(<table>)
14063 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14064 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14065 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14066 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14067 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14068
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014069table_gpc0(<table>)
14070 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14071 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14072 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14073 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14074 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14075
14076table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14077 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14078 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14079 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14080 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14081 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14082 sample fetch keyword.
14083
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014084table_gpc1(<table>)
14085 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14086 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14087 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14088 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14089 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14090
14091table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14092 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14093 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14094 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14095 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14096 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14097 sample fetch keyword.
14098
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014099table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14100 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14101 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014102 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014103 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14104 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14105
14106table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14107 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14108 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14109 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14110 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14111 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14112 keyword.
14113
14114table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14115 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14116 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014117 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014118 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14119 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14120
14121table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14122 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14123 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14124 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14125 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14126 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14127 keyword.
14128
14129table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14130 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14131 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014132 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014133 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14134 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14135 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14136 keyword.
14137
14138table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14139 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14140 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014141 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014142 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14143 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14144 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14145 keyword.
14146
14147table_server_id(<table>)
14148 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14149 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14150 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14151 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14152 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14153 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14154
14155table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14156 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14157 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014158 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014159 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14160 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14161 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14162 keyword.
14163
14164table_sess_rate(<table>)
14165 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14166 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14167 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14168 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14169 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14170 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14171 keyword.
14172
14173table_trackers(<table>)
14174 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14175 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14176 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14177 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14178 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14179 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14180 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14181 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14182 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14183 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14184
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014185upper
14186 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14187 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14188 type. The result is of type string.
14189
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014190url_dec
14191 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14192 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14193
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014194ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014195 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014196 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14197 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14198 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014199 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14200 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14201 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14202 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014203 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014204 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14205 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014206
14207 Example:
14208 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14209 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14210
14211 message Point {
14212 int32 latitude = 1;
14213 int32 longitude = 2;
14214 }
14215
14216 message PPoint {
14217 Point point = 59;
14218 }
14219
14220 message Rectangle {
14221 // One corner of the rectangle.
14222 PPoint lo = 48;
14223 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14224 PPoint hi = 49;
14225 }
14226
14227 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14228 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14229 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14230
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014231 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14232 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14233 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
14234 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14235
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014236 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014237
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014238 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014239
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014240 As a gRPC message is alway made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
14241 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14242 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14243
14244 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14245 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14246 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14247
14248 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14249 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14250 interpret the previous binary sample.
14251
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014252
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014253unset-var(<var name>)
14254 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14255 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14256 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14257 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14258 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14259 response),
14260 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14261 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14262 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14263 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14264
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014265utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14266 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14267 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14268 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14269 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14270 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14271 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14272
14273 Example :
14274
14275 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014276 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014277 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14278
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014279word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14280 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14281 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14282 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14283 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14284 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14285
14286 Example :
14287 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14288 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14289 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14290 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14291 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014292
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014293wt6([<avalanche>])
14294 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14295 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14296 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14297 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14298 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14299 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14300 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014301 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14302 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014303
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014304xor(<value>)
14305 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014306 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014307 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014308 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014309 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014310 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14311 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014312 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014313 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14314 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014315 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014316 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014317
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014318xxh32([<seed>])
14319 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14320 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14321 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14322 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14323 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14324 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14325 as cryptographically secure.
14326
14327xxh64([<seed>])
14328 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14329 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14330 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14331 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14332 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14333 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14334 as cryptographically secure.
14335
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014336
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143377.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014338--------------------------------------------
14339
14340A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14341not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14342"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14343The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14344
14345always_false : boolean
14346 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14347 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14348
14349always_true : boolean
14350 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14351 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14352
14353avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014354 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014355 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14356 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14357 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14358 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14359 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14360 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14361 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14362 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14363 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14364 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14365 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14366 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14367 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014369be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014370 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14371 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14372 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14373 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014374 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14375
14376be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14377 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14378 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14379 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14380 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14381 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014382 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14383 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014384
14385 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14386 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14387 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014389be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14390 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14391 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14392 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014393 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014394 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14395 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014396
14397 Example :
14398 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14399 backend dynamic
14400 mode http
14401 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14402 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014403
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014404bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014405 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14406 of the string.
14407
14408bool(<bool>) : bool
14409 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14410 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014412connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14413 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014414 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014415 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14416 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014417
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014418 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014419 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014420 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14421
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014422 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14423 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014424
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014425 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014426 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014427 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014428 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014429 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014430 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014431 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014432
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014433 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14434 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014435 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014436 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014437
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014438cpu_calls : integer
14439 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14440 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14441 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14442 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14443 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14444 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14445
14446cpu_ns_avg : integer
14447 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14448 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14449 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14450 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14451 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14452 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14453 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14454 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14455 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14456 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14457 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14458
14459cpu_ns_tot : integer
14460 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14461 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14462 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14463 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14464 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14465 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14466 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14467 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14468 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14469 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14470 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14471 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14472 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14473
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014474date([<offset>]) : integer
14475 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14476 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14477 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14478 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014479 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14480
14481 Example :
14482
14483 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14484 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014485
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014486date_us : integer
14487 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14488 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14489 from the same timeval structure.
14490
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014491distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14492 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14493 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14494 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14495 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14496 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14497 list of supported tokens.
14498
14499distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14500 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14501 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14502 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14503 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14504 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14505 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14506 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14507 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14508 supported tokens.
14509
14510 Example :
14511 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14512 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14513 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14514 # send large files to the big farm
14515 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14516
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014517env(<name>) : string
14518 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14519 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14520 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14521 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14522 certain way.
14523
14524 Examples :
14525 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14526 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14527
14528 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14529 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014531fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14532 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014533 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14534 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014535 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14536 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014537 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014538 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14539 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014540
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014541fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14542 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14543 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14544 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014546fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14547 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14548 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14549 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14550 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14551 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14552 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14553 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14554 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014555
14556 Example :
14557 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14558 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14559 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14560 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14561 frontend mail
14562 bind :25
14563 mode tcp
14564 maxconn 100
14565 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14566 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14567 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14568 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014569
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014570hostname : string
14571 Returns the system hostname.
14572
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014573int(<integer>) : signed integer
14574 Returns a signed integer.
14575
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014576ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14577 Returns an ipv4.
14578
14579ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14580 Returns an ipv6.
14581
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014582lat_ns_avg : integer
14583 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14584 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14585 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14586 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14587 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14588 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14589 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14590 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14591 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14592 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14593 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14594 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14595 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14596 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14597
14598lat_ns_tot : integer
14599 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14600 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14601 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14602 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14603 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14604 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14605 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14606 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14607 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14608 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14609 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14610 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14611 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14612 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14613 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14614 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14615 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14616 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14617 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14618
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014619meth(<method>) : method
14620 Returns a method.
14621
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014622nbproc : integer
14623 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14624 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14625 and debugging purposes.
14626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014627nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14628 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14629 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14630 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014631 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14632 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14633 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014634
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014635prio_class : integer
14636 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14637 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14638 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14639
14640prio_offset : integer
14641 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14642 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14643 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14644 set-priority-offset".
14645
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014646proc : integer
14647 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14648 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14649 debugging purposes.
14650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014651queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014652 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14653 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14654 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014655 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14656 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14657 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14658 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14659 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14660
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014661rand([<range>]) : integer
14662 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14663 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14664 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14665 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14666 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014668srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14669 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14670 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14671 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14672 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14673 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014674 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14675 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14676
14677srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14678 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14679 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14680 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14681 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14682 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14683 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14684 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14685
14686 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14687 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014688
14689srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14690 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14691 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14692 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014693 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014694 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14695 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14696 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14697
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014698srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14699 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14700 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14701 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14702 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14703 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14704 fetch methods.
14705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014706srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14707 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14708 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014709 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014710 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14711 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014712 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014713 overloading servers).
14714
14715 Example :
14716 # Redirect to a separate back
14717 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14718 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14719 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14720
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014721stopping : boolean
14722 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14723 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14724 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14725
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014726str(<string>) : string
14727 Returns a string.
14728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014729table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14730 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14731 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14732
14733table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14734 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14735 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14736 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14737
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014738thread : integer
14739 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14740 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14741 and debugging purposes.
14742
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014743var(<var-name>) : undefined
14744 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014745 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14746 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014747 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014748 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14749 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014750 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014751 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14752 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014753 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014754 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014755
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147567.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014757----------------------------------
14758
14759The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14760closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14761methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14762sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14763TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014764the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14765counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014766"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14767used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14768can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14769Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14770table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14771tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14772currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014773
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014774bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014775 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14776 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14777 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014779be_id : integer
14780 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14781 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14782
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014783be_name : string
14784 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14785 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014787dst : ip
14788 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14789 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14790 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14791 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014792 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14793 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14794 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14795 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14796 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14797 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014798
14799dst_conn : integer
14800 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14801 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14802 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14803 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14804 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14805 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14806 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14807 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014808
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014809dst_is_local : boolean
14810 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14811 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14812 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14813 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014814 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014815 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14816 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14817 it only once per connection.
14818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014819dst_port : integer
14820 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14821 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14822 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14823 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14824 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14825 an HTTP header.
14826
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014827fc_http_major : integer
14828 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14829 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14830 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14831
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014832fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14833 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14834 header.
14835
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014836fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14837 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14838 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14839 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14840 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14841 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14842 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14843
14844fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14845 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14846 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14847 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14848 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14849 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14850 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14851
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014852fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14853 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14854 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14855 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14856 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14857
14858fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14859 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14860 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14861 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14862 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14863
14864fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14865 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14866 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14867 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14868 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14869
14870fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14871 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14872 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14873 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14874 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14875
14876fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14877 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14878 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14879 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14880 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14881
14882fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14883 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14884 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14885 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14886 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14887
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014888fe_defbe : string
14889 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14890 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014892fe_id : integer
14893 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014894 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014895 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14896
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014897fe_name : string
14898 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14899 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14900 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14901
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014902sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014903sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14904sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14905sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014906 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14907 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14908 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14909
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014910sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014911sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14912sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14913sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014914 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14915 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14916 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14917
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014918sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014919sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14920sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14921sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014922 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14923 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014924 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14925 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14926 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014927
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014928 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014929 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14930 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014931 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14932 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14933 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014934 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14935 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14936
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014937sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14938sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14939sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14940sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14941 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14942 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14943 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14944 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14945 when a first ACL was verified.
14946
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014947sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014948sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14949sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14950sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014951 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014952 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14953
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014954sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014955sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14956sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14957sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014958 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14959 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14960 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14961
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014962sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014963sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14964sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14965sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014966 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14967 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14968 See also src_conn_rate.
14969
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014970sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014971sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14972sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14973sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014974 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014975 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014976
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014977sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14978sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14979sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14980sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14981 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14982 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14983
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014984sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14985sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14986sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14987sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14988 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14989 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14990
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014991sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014992sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14993sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14994sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014995 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14996 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14997 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014998 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14999 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15000 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015001
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015002sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15003sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15004sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15005sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15006 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15007 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15008 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15009 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15010 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15011 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15012
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015013sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015014sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15015sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15016sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015017 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015018 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15019 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15020
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015021sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015022sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15023sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15024sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015025 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15026 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15027 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15028 src_http_err_rate.
15029
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015030sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015031sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15032sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15033sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015034 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015035 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15036 src_http_req_cnt.
15037
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015038sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015039sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15040sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15041sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015042 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15043 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15044 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15045 src_http_req_rate.
15046
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015047sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015048sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15049sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15050sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015051 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015052 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15053 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15054 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15055 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015056
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015057 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015058 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15059 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015060 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15061
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015062sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15063sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15064sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15065sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15066 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15067 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15068 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15069 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15070 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15071
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015072sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015073sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15074sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15075sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015076 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15077 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15078 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015079
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015080sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015081sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15082sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15083sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015084 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15085 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15086 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015087
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015088sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015089sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15090sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15091sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015092 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015093 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15094 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15095 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015096 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015097 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15098
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015099sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015100sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15101sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15102sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015103 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15104 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15105 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15106 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15107 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015108 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015109
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015110sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015111sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15112sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15113sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015114 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15115 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15116 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15117
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015118sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015119sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15120sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15121sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015122 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15123 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015124 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015125 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15126 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015127 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15128 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15129 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015131so_id : integer
15132 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15133 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15134 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015136src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015137 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015138 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15139 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15140 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015141 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15142 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15143 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015144 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15145 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15146 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15147 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15148 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15149 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15150 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015151
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015152 Example:
15153 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15154 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015156src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15157 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15158 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15159 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015160 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015162src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15163 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15164 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015165 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015166 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015168src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15169 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15170 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15171 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15172 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15173 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15174 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015175
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015176 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015177 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15178 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15179 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15180 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015181 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015182 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15183 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15184
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015185src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15186 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15187 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15188 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15189 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15190 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15191 was verified.
15192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015194 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015195 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015196 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015197 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015199src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015200 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015201 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15202 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015203 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015205src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15206 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15207 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15208 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015209 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015211src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015212 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015213 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015214 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015215 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015216
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015217src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15218 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15219 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15220 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15221 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15222
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015223src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15224 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15225 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15226 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15227 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015229src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015230 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015231 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015232 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15233 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015234 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15235 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15236 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015237
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015238src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15239 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15240 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15241 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15242 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15243 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15244 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15245 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015247src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015248 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015249 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015250 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015251 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015252 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015254src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15255 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15256 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15257 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15258 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015259 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015261src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015262 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015263 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15264 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015265 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015267src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15268 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15269 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15270 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015271 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015272 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015274src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15275 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15276 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15277 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015278 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015279 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15280 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015281
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015282 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015283 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015284 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015285 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015286
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015287src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15288 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15289 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15290 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15291 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15292 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15293 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15294
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015295src_is_local : boolean
15296 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15297 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15298 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15299 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015300 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015301 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15302 once per connection.
15303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015304src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015305 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15306 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15307 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15308 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15309 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015311src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015312 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15313 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15314 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15315 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15316 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015318src_port : integer
15319 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15320 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15321 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15322 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015324src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015325 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015326 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15327 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15328 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015329 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015331src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15332 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15333 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15334 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15335 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015336 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015338src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15339 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15340 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15341 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15342 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15343 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15344 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15345 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15346 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015347
15348 Example :
15349 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15350 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15351 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15352 listen ssh
15353 bind :22
15354 mode tcp
15355 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015356 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015357 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015358 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015360srv_id : integer
15361 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15362 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15363 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015364
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200153657.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015366----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015368The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15369closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15370when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15371usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015372future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015373
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001537451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15375 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15376 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15377 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15378 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15379 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15380
15381 Example :
15382 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15383 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15384 # the request.
15385 frontend http-in
15386 bind *:8081
15387 default_backend servers
15388 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15389 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15390
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015391ssl_bc : boolean
15392 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15393 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15394 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15395
15396ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15397 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15398 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15399
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015400ssl_bc_alpn : string
15401 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15402 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15403 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15404 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15405 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15406 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15407 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15408 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15409 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15410
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015411ssl_bc_cipher : string
15412 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15413 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15414
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015415ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15416 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15417 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15418 session or a TLS ticket.
15419
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015420ssl_bc_npn : string
15421 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15422 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15423 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15424 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15425 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15426 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15427 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15428 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15429
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015430ssl_bc_protocol : string
15431 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15432 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15433
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015434ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015435 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015436 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15437 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015438
15439ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15440 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15441 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15442 if session was reused or not.
15443
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015444ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15445 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15446 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15447 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15448 BoringSSL.
15449
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015450ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15451 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15452 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015454ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15455 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15456 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15457 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15458 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15459 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15462 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15463 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15464 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15465 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015466
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015467ssl_c_der : binary
15468 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15469 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15470 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472ssl_c_err : integer
15473 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15474 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15475 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15476 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15477 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15480 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15481 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15482 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15483 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15484 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15485 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15486 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15487 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489ssl_c_key_alg : string
15490 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15491 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15492 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015494ssl_c_notafter : string
15495 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15496 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15497 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015499ssl_c_notbefore : string
15500 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15501 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15502 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015504ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15505 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15506 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15507 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15508 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15509 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15510 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15511 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15512 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514ssl_c_serial : binary
15515 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15516 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15517 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015519ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15520 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15521 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15522 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015523 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15524 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15525
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015526 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015527 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015529ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15530 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15531 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15532 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015534ssl_c_used : boolean
15535 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15536 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538ssl_c_verify : integer
15539 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15540 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15541 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15542 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544ssl_c_version : integer
15545 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15546 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015547
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015548ssl_f_der : binary
15549 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15550 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15551 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15554 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15555 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15556 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15557 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015558 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015559 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15560 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15561 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563ssl_f_key_alg : string
15564 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15565 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15566 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015568ssl_f_notafter : string
15569 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15570 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15571 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015573ssl_f_notbefore : string
15574 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15575 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15576 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015578ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15579 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15580 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15581 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15582 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15583 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15584 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15585 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15586 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015588ssl_f_serial : binary
15589 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15590 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15591 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015592
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015593ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15594 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15595 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15596 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015598ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15599 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15600 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15601 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015603ssl_f_version : integer
15604 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15605 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15606
15607ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015608 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15609 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15610 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612 Example :
15613 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15614 listen http-https
15615 bind :80
15616 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15617 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15618
15619ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15620 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15621 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15622
15623ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015624 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15626 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15627 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15628 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15629 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15630 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15631 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15632 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634ssl_fc_cipher : string
15635 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15636 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015637
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015638ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15639 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15640 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015641 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015642
15643ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15644 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15645 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015646 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015647
15648ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15649 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15650 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15651 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015652 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015653 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015654
15655ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15656 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15657 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015658 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015661 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15662 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015663 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15664 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15665 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15666 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015667
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015668ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15669 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15670 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15671 wait until the handshake happened.
15672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015673ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15674 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015675 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15676 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15677 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15678 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015679
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015680ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015681 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015682 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15683 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015685ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015686 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15688 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15689 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15690 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15691 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15692 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15693 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695ssl_fc_protocol : string
15696 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15697 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015698
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015699ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015700 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015701 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15702 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15705 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15706 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15707 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15708 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015709
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015710ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15711 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15712 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15713 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15714 BoringSSL.
15715
15716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717ssl_fc_sni : string
15718 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15719 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15720 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15721 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15722 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15723
15724 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15725 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15726 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015727 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15728 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15732 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15735 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15736 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015737
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015738
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157397.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015740------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015742Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15743sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15744only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15745For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15746be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15747can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15748sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15749for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15750content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015752payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015753 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15755 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15758 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015759 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015760 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015761
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015762req.hdrs : string
15763 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15764 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15765 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15766 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15767
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015768req.hdrs_bin : binary
15769 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15770 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15771 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15772 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15773 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15774 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15775
15776 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15777
15778 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15779 str: <int:length><bytes>
15780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015781req.len : integer
15782req_len : integer (deprecated)
15783 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15784 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15785 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15786 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15787 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15788 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15789 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15790 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015792req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15793 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015794 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15795 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15796 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15797 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015799 ACL alternatives :
15800 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015802req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15803 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15804 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15805 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15806 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808 ACL alternatives :
15809 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015811 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015813req.proto_http : boolean
15814req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15815 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15816 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15817 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15818 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15819 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15820 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15821 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015823 Example:
15824 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15825 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15826 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015827 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015829req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15830rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15831 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15832 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15833 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15834 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15835 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15836 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15837 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015839 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15840 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15841 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15842 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15843 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15844 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015846 ACL derivatives :
15847 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015849 Example :
15850 listen tse-farm
15851 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15852 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15853 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15854 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15855 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15856 persist rdp-cookie
15857 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15858 # This is only useful makes sense if
15859 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15860 stick-table type string size 204800
15861 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15862 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15863 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015865 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15866 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015868req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15869rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15870 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15871 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15872 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15873 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015875 ACL derivatives :
15876 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015877
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015878req.ssl_alpn : string
15879 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15880 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15881 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15882 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15883 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15884 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015885 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015886
15887 Examples :
15888 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15889 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15890 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015891 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015892 default_backend bk_default
15893
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015894req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15895 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15896 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015897 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15898 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15899 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15900 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15901 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15904req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15905 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15906 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15907 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15908 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15909 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15910 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15911 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913req.ssl_sni : string
15914req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15915 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15916 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15917 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15918 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15919 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15920 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15921 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15922 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15923 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15924 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15925 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15926 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015928 ACL derivatives :
15929 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015931 Examples :
15932 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15933 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15934 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15935 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15936 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015937
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015938req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15939 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15940 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15941 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15942 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15943 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15944 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15945 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15946 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15947 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949req.ssl_ver : integer
15950req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15951 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15952 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15953 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15954 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15955 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15956 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15957 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015958 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015959 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015961 ACL derivatives :
15962 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015963
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015964res.len : integer
15965 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15966 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15967 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15968 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15969 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15970 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15971 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15972 content inspection.
15973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015974res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15975 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015976 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15977 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15978 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15979 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015981res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15982 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15983 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15984 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15985 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015987 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015988
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015989res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15990rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15991 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15992 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15993 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15994 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15995 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15996 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15997 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015999wait_end : boolean
16000 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16001 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016002 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16004 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016005 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016006 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16007 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009 Examples :
16010 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16011 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16012 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16015 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16016 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16017 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16018 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16019 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16020 tcp-request content reject
16021
16022
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160237.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016024--------------------------------------
16025
16026It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16027This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16028data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16029its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16030HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16031content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16032to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16033more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16034response are indexed.
16035
16036base : string
16037 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16038 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16039 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16040 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16041 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16042 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16043 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16044 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16045
16046 ACL derivatives :
16047 base : exact string match
16048 base_beg : prefix match
16049 base_dir : subdir match
16050 base_dom : domain match
16051 base_end : suffix match
16052 base_len : length match
16053 base_reg : regex match
16054 base_sub : substring match
16055
16056base32 : integer
16057 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16058 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16059 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016060 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16061 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16062 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063
16064base32+src : binary
16065 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16066 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16067 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16068 per-URL counters.
16069
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016070capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16071 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16072 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16073 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16074
16075capture.req.method : string
16076 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16077 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16078 because it's allocated.
16079
16080capture.req.uri : string
16081 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16082 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16083 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16084 allocated.
16085
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016086capture.req.ver : string
16087 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16088 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16089 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16090
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016091capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16092 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16093 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16094 The first entry is an index of 0.
16095 See also: "capture response header"
16096
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016097capture.res.ver : string
16098 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16099 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16100 persistent flag.
16101
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016102req.body : binary
16103 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16104 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16105 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16106 the first chunk is analyzed.
16107
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016108req.body_param([<name>) : string
16109 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16110 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16111 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16112 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16113 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16114 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16115 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16116 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16117 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16118 given.
16119
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016120req.body_len : integer
16121 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16122 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16123 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16124 "option http-buffer-request".
16125
16126req.body_size : integer
16127 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16128 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16129 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16130 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16131 "option http-buffer-request".
16132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016133req.cook([<name>]) : string
16134cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16135 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16136 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16137 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16138 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16139 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16140 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16141 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16142 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16143
16144 ACL derivatives :
16145 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16146 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16147 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16148 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16149 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16150 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16151 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16152 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016154req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16155cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16156 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16157 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016159req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16160cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16161 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16162 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16163 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16164 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016166cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16167 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16168 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16169 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16170 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016171 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016172 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16173 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16174 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16175 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016177hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16178 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16179 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16180 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16181 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016182 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016184req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16185 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16186 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16187 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16188 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16189 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16190 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16191 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16192 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016194req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16195 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16196 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16197 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16198 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016200req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16201 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16202 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16203 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16204 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16205 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16206 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16207 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16208 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016209 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016210 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016211 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016213 ACL derivatives :
16214 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16215 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16216 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16217 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16218 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16219 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16220 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16221 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16222
16223req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16224hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16225 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16226 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16227 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16228 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16229 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16230 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16231 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16232 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16233 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16234
16235req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16236hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16237 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16238 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16239 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16240 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16241 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016242 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016243 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16244 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16245
16246req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16247hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16248 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16249 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16250 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16251 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16252 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16253 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16254 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16255
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016256
16257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016258http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16259 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16260 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16261 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16262 basic auth is supported.
16263
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016264http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16265 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16266 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16267 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16268 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016269 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16270 basic auth is supported.
16271
16272 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016273 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16274 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16275 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16276 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016277
16278http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016279 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16280 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016281 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16282 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016284method : integer + string
16285 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16286 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16287 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16288 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16289 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16290 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16291 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016293 ACL derivatives :
16294 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016296 Example :
16297 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16298 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16299 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016301path : string
16302 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16303 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16304 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16305 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16306 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016307 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016308 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016310 ACL derivatives :
16311 path : exact string match
16312 path_beg : prefix match
16313 path_dir : subdir match
16314 path_dom : domain match
16315 path_end : suffix match
16316 path_len : length match
16317 path_reg : regex match
16318 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016319
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016320query : string
16321 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16322 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16323 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16324 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016325 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016326 which stops before the question mark.
16327
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016328req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16329 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16330 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16331 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16332 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016334req.ver : string
16335req_ver : string (deprecated)
16336 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16337 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16338 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016340 ACL derivatives :
16341 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016343res.comp : boolean
16344 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16345 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16346 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016348res.comp_algo : string
16349 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16350 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16351 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016353res.cook([<name>]) : string
16354scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16355 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16356 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16357 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016359 ACL derivatives :
16360 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016362res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16363scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16364 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16365 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16366 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016368res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16369scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16370 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16371 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16372 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016374res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16375 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16376 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16377 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16378 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16379 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16380 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16381 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16382 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16383 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016385res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16386 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16387 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16388 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16389 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16390 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016392res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16393shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16394 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16395 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16396 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16397 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16398 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16399 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16400 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16401 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016403 ACL derivatives :
16404 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16405 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16406 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16407 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16408 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16409 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16410 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16411 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16412
16413res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16414shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16415 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16416 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16417 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16418 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16419 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016421res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16422shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16423 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16424 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16425 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16426 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16427 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16428 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016429
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016430res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16431 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16432 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16433 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16434 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016436res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16437shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16438 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16439 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16440 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16441 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16442 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16443 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016445res.ver : string
16446resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16447 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16448 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016450 ACL derivatives :
16451 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016453set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16454 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16455 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016456 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016457 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016459 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16460 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016462status : integer
16463 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16464 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16465 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016466
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016467unique-id : string
16468 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16469 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16470 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16471 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16472 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16473 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016475url : string
16476 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16477 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16478 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16479 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16480 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16481 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16482 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016484 ACL derivatives :
16485 url : exact string match
16486 url_beg : prefix match
16487 url_dir : subdir match
16488 url_dom : domain match
16489 url_end : suffix match
16490 url_len : length match
16491 url_reg : regex match
16492 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016494url_ip : ip
16495 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16496 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16497 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16498 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16499 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16500 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16501 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016503url_port : integer
16504 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16505 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16506 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16507 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016508
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016509urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16510url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016511 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16512 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016513 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16514 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16515 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16516 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016517 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16518 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016519 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16520 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016522 ACL derivatives :
16523 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16524 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16525 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16526 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16527 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16528 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16529 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16530 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016531
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016533 Example :
16534 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16535 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16536 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16537 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016538
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016539urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016540 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16541 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16542 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016543
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016544url32 : integer
16545 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16546 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16547 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16548 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16549 is an unsigned integer.
16550
16551url32+src : binary
16552 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16553 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16554 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16555
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200165577.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016558---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016560Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16561every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016562order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016563
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016564ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16565---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016566FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016567HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016568HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16569HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016570HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16571HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16572HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16573HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16574LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016575METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016576METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016577METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16578METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16579METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16580METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016581METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016582METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016583RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016584REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016585TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016586WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16587---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016588
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165908. Logging
16591----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016592
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016593One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16594provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16595very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16596provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16597state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016598to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016599headers.
16600
16601In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16602about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16603send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16604
16605 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16606 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16607 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16608 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16609 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016610 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016611 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016612
16613The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16614allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16615as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16616while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16617real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16618delay.
16619
16620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166218.1. Log levels
16622---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016623
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016624TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016625source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016626HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16627in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16628track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16629syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16630about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016631
16632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166338.2. Log formats
16634----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016635
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016636HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016637and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16638slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16639options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016640
16641 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16642 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16643 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16644 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16645 extents.
16646
16647 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16648 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16649 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16650 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16651 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16652
16653 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16654 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16655 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16656 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16657 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16658
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016659 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16660 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16661 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16662 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16663
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016664 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16665
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016666Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16667specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16668field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16669servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16670always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16671identifier.
16672
16673Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16674 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16675 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16676 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16677 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16678
16679
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166808.2.1. Default log format
16681-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016682
16683This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16684as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16685format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16686
16687 Example :
16688 listen www
16689 mode http
16690 log global
16691 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16692
16693 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16694 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16695 (www/HTTP)
16696
16697 Field Format Extract from the example above
16698 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16699 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16700 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16701 4 'to' to
16702 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16703 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16704
16705Detailed fields description :
16706 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16707 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16708 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16709 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16710 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16711 and processed the connection.
16712 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16713
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016714In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16715"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16716connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16717
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016718It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16719will eventually disappear.
16720
16721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167228.2.2. TCP log format
16723---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016724
16725The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16726is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16727information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16728counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16729emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16730environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16731the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16732sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016733specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16734not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16735fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16736marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016737
16738 Example :
16739 frontend fnt
16740 mode tcp
16741 option tcplog
16742 log global
16743 default_backend bck
16744
16745 backend bck
16746 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16747
16748 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16749 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16750 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16751
16752 Field Format Extract from the example above
16753 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16754 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16755 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16756 4 frontend_name fnt
16757 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16758 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16759 7 bytes_read* 212
16760 8 termination_state --
16761 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16762 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16763
16764Detailed fields description :
16765 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016766 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16767 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16768 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016769 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016770 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016771 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016772
16773 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016774 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16775 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16776 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016777
16778 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16779 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16780 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016781 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16782 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16783 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16784 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016785
16786 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16787 and processed the connection.
16788
16789 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16790 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16791 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16792 applications.
16793
16794 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16795 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16796 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16797 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16798 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16799
16800 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16801 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16802 See "Timers" below for more details.
16803
16804 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16805 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16806 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16807 "Timers" below for more details.
16808
16809 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016810 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016811 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16812 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16813 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16814 details.
16815
16816 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16817 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16818 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16819 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16820 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16821
16822 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16823 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16824 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16825 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16826 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16827 for more details.
16828
16829 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016830 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016831 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16832 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16833 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016834 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016835
16836 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16837 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16838 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16839 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16840 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16841 caused by a denial of service attack.
16842
16843 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16844 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16845 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16846 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16847 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16848 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16849 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16850 denial of service attack.
16851
16852 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16853 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16854 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16855 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16856 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16857 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16858 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16859 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16860 be processed than on other servers.
16861
16862 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16863 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16864 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16865 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16866 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16867 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16868 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16869 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16870 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16871 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16872 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16873 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16874 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16875
16876 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16877 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16878 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16879 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16880 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16881 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016882 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016883 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16884
16885 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16886 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16887 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16888 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16889 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16890 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016891 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016892 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16893 occurs.
16894
16895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168968.2.3. HTTP log format
16897----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016898
16899The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16900is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16901the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16902are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16903emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16904generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16905"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16906which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016907frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16908is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016909
16910Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16911slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16912with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16913
16914 Example :
16915 frontend http-in
16916 mode http
16917 option httplog
16918 log global
16919 default_backend bck
16920
16921 backend static
16922 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16923
16924 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16925 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16926 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016927 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016928
16929 Field Format Extract from the example above
16930 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16931 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016932 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016933 4 frontend_name http-in
16934 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016935 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016936 7 status_code 200
16937 8 bytes_read* 2750
16938 9 captured_request_cookie -
16939 10 captured_response_cookie -
16940 11 termination_state ----
16941 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16942 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16943 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16944 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16945 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016946
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016947Detailed fields description :
16948 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016949 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16950 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16951 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016952 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016953 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016954 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016955
16956 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016957 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16958 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16959 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016960
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016961 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16962 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016963
16964 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16965 and processed the connection.
16966
16967 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16968 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16969 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16970
16971 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16972 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16973 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16974 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16975 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16976 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16977
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016978 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16979 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16980 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16981 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16982 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16983 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016984 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16985 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016986
16987 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16988 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016989 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016990
16991 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16992 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016993 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16994 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016995
16996 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16997 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16998 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16999 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17000 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017001 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17002 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017003
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017004 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17005 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17006 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17007 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17008 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17009 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17010 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017011 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017012
17013 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17014 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17015 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17016
17017 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17018 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
17019 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
17020 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17021 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17022 overflowing.
17023
17024 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17025 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17026 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17027 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17028 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17029 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17030 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17031 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17032
17033 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17034 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17035 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17036 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17037 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17038 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17039 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17040 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17041
17042 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17043 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17044 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17045 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17046 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17047 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17048 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17049
17050 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017051 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017052 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17053 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17054 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017055 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017056 system.
17057
17058 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17059 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17060 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17061 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17062 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17063 caused by a denial of service attack.
17064
17065 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17066 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17067 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17068 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17069 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17070 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17071 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17072 denial of service attack.
17073
17074 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17075 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17076 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17077 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17078 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17079 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17080 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17081 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17082 processed than on other servers.
17083
17084 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17085 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17086 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17087 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17088 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17089 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17090 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17091 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17092 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17093 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17094 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17095 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17096 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17097
17098 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17099 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17100 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17101 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17102 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17103 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017104 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017105 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17106
17107 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17108 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17109 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17110 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17111 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17112 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017113 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017114 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17115 occurs.
17116
17117 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17118 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17119 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17120 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17121 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17122 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17123 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17124 cookies" below for more details.
17125
17126 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17127 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17128 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17129 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17130 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17131 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17132 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17133 and cookies" below for more details.
17134
17135 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17136 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17137 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17138 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17139 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17140 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17141 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17142 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17143
17144
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200171458.2.4. Custom log format
17146------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017147
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017148The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017149mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017150
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017151HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017152Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17153separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17154prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17155
17156Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17157variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017158("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017159
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017160If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017161as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017162less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17163the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17164
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017165Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017166In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017167in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017168
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017169Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17170'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17171https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17172such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17173
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017174Flags are :
17175 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017176 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017177 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17178 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017179
17180 Example:
17181
17182 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17183 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17184
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017185 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17186
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017187At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17188
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017189 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17190 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017191
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017192the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017193
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017194 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17195 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17196 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017197
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017198and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17199
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017200 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17201 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017202
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017203Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17204
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017205 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017206 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017207 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17208 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17209 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017210 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17211 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17212 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017213 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017214 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17215 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017216 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017217 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17218 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017219 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017220 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017221 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017222 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017223 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017224 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017225 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017226 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17227 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17228 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17229 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17230 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017231 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017232 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17233 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017234 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017235 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17236 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017237 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17238 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17239 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017240 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017241 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17242 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017243 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017244 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17245 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17246 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017247 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017248 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017249 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17250 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17251 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17252 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017253 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017254 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017255 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017256 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017257 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017258 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017259 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17260 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17261 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017262 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017263 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17264 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017265 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017266 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17267 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017268 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017269 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017270 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017271 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017272
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017273 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017274
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017275
172768.2.5. Error log format
17277-----------------------
17278
17279When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17280protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17281By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17282"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017283will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017284logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17285
17286The format looks like this :
17287
17288 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17289 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17290 Connection error during SSL handshake
17291
17292 Field Format Extract from the example above
17293 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17294 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17295 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17296 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17297 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17298
17299These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17300failures.
17301
17302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173038.3. Advanced logging options
17304-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017305
17306Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17307just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17308options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17309for more information about their usage.
17310
17311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173128.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17313------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017314
17315It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17316haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17317commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17318monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17319ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17320
17321 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17322 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17323 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17324 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17325
17326 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17327 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17328 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017329 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017330 such as other load-balancers.
17331
17332 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17333 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17334 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17335
17336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173378.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17338----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017339
17340The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17341what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17342or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017343"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017344just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17345log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17346after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17347is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17348with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17349with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17350
17351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173528.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17353------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017354
17355Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17356for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17357"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17358retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17359raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17360a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17361file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17362you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17363"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17364
17365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173668.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17367--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017368
17369Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17370multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17371them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17372"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17373logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17374error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17375and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17376too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17377useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17378alternative.
17379
17380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173818.4. Timing events
17382------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017383
17384Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17385reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17386the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17387frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017388mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17389addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17390
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017391Timings events in HTTP mode:
17392
17393 first request 2nd request
17394 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17395 t tr t tr ...
17396 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17397 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17398 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17399 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17400 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17401
17402Timings events in TCP mode:
17403
17404 TCP session
17405 |<----------------->|
17406 t t
17407 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17408 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17409 |<------ Tt ------->|
17410
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017411 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017412 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017413 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17414 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17415 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017416 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017417 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17418 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17419 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17420 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017421
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017422 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17423 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17424 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017425 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17426 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17427 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17428 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17429 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17430 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017431
17432 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17433 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17434 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17435 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17436 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17437 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17438 request typed by hand during a test.
17439
17440 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17441 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017442 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017443 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17444 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17445 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17446 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017447
17448 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17449 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17450 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17451 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17452 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17453
17454 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17455 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17456 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17457 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17458 connection never established.
17459
17460 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17461 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17462 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17463 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17464 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17465 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17466 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17467 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17468 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17469 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17470 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17471
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017472 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17473 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17474 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17475 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17476 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17477 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17478
17479 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17480
17481 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17482 "Ta" can never be negative.
17483
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017484 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17485 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017486 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17487 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017488 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017489
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017490 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017491
17492 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017493 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17494 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017495
17496These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17497protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17498that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017499due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17500"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17501that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017502
17503Most common cases :
17504
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017505 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17506 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17507 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17508 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17509 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17510 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17511 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17512 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17513 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17514 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17515 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017516 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017517
17518 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17519 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17520 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17521 of ms on remote networks.
17522
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017523 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17524 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17525 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017526
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017527 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17528 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17529 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17530 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17531 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17532 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17533 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17534 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17535 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017536
17537Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17538
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017539 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017540 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017541 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017542
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017543 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017544 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17545 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17546
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017547 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017548 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17549 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17550 flags.
17551
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017552 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17553 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017554 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17555 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17556 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17557 the client connection was maintained open.
17558
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017559 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017560 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017561 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017562 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17563
17564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175658.5. Session state at disconnection
17566-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017567
17568TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17569"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
175702-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17571each of which has a special meaning :
17572
17573 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17574 session to terminate :
17575
17576 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17577
17578 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17579 server explicitly refused it.
17580
17581 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17582 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17583 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17584 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017585 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017586
17587 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17588 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017589
17590 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17591 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17592 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17593 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17594 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17595
17596 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17597 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17598 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17599 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17600 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17601
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017602 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17603 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17604
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017605 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17606 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17607 backup connections when going up.
17608
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017609 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17610
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017611 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17612 send or receive data.
17613
17614 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17615 send or receive data.
17616
17617 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17618 with nothing left in the buffers.
17619
17620 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17621
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017622 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017623 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17624
17625 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17626 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17627 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17628 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17629 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17630
17631 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17632 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17633
17634 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17635 server (HTTP only).
17636
17637 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17638
17639 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17640 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17641 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17642
17643 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17644 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17645 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17646
17647 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17648
17649 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17650 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17651
17652 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17653 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17654 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17655
17656 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17657 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017658 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17659 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017660
17661 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17662 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17663 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17664 another server.
17665
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017666 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017667 server.
17668
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017669 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17670 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17671 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17672 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17673
17674 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17675 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17676 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17677 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17678
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017679 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17680 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17681 "use-server" rule).
17682
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017683 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17684
17685 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17686 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17687
17688 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17689
17690 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17691 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17692 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17693
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017694 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17695 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017696 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017697 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17698 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17699
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017700 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17701
17702 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17703 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17704
17705 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17706
17707 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17708
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017709The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17710was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017711helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17712starvation, attacks, etc...
17713
17714The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17715alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17716easier finding and understanding.
17717
17718 Flags Reason
17719
17720 -- Normal termination.
17721
17722 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17723 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17724 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17725 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17726
17727 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17728 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17729 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17730 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17731 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17732 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017733
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017734 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17735 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017736 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017737
17738 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17739 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17740 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17741
17742 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17743 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17744 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17745 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17746 the server takes too long to respond.
17747
17748 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17749 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17750 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17751 long a time to respond.
17752
17753 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17754 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17755 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17756 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017757 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17758 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017759
17760 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17761 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17762 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17763 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17764 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017765 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017766 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17767 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17768 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17769 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17770 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17771 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17772 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17773 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017774 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017775 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17776 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17777 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017778
17779 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17780 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017781 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17782 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17783 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17784 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017785
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017786 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17787 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17788
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017789 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017790 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17791 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017792 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017793 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17794 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17795
17796 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17797 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17798 503 or 504 here.
17799
17800 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17801 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17802 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17803 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17804 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17805
17806 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17807 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017808 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017809 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17810 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17811
17812 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17813 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17814 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17815 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17816 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17817 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17818 between haproxy and the server.
17819
17820 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17821 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17822 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17823 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17824 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17825 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17826 solution is to fix the application.
17827
17828 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17829 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17830 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17831 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17832 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17833 external attacks.
17834
17835 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17836 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017837 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017838 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17839 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17840
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017841 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17842 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17843 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017844 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017845 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017846
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017847 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17848 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17849 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17850 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017851 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17852 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17853 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17854 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17855 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017856
17857 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17858 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17859 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17860 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17861
17862 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17863 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17864 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17865 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17866
17867 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17868 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17869 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17870 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17871
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017872The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17873persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17874important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17875re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17876
17877 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17878
17879 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17880 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17881 set on a GET request.
17882
17883 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17884 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017885 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017886 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17887
17888 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17889 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17890 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17891
17892 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17893 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17894 already got a cookie.
17895
17896 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17897 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17898 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17899 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17900 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17901
17902 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17903 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17904 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17905
17906 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17907 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17908 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17909
17910 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17911 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17912
17913 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17914 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17915 then advertised in the response.
17916
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179188.6. Non-printable characters
17919-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017920
17921In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17922consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17923converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17924prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17925being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17926escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17927is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17928'}' when logging headers.
17929
17930Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17931issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17932containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17933
17934Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17935the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17936performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17937
17938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179398.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17940---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017941
17942Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17943achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017944section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017945cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17946the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17947the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017948locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017949not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17950user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17951a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17952wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17953
17954 Examples :
17955 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17956 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17957
17958 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17959 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17960
17961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179628.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17963---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017964
17965Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17966proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17967the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17968server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17969
17970Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17971response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017972section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017973
17974It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017975time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17976appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017977are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17978and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17979follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17980request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17981in the logs.
17982
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017983As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17984frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17985an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17986
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017987 Example :
17988 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17989 listen proxy-out
17990 mode http
17991 option httplog
17992 option logasap
17993 log global
17994 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17995
17996 # log the name of the virtual server
17997 capture request header Host len 20
17998
17999 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18000 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18001
18002 # log the beginning of the referrer
18003 capture request header Referer len 20
18004
18005 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18006 capture response header Server len 20
18007
18008 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18009 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18010
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018011 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018012 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18013
18014 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18015 capture response header Via len 20
18016
18017 # log the URL location during a redirection
18018 capture response header Location len 20
18019
18020 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18021 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18022 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18023 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18024 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18025
18026 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18027 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18028 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18029 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018030 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018031
18032 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18033 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18034 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18035 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18036 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018037 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018038
18039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180408.9. Examples of logs
18041---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018042
18043These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18044them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18045reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18046
18047 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18048 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18049 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18050
18051 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18052 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18053
18054 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18055 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18056 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18057
18058 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18059 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18060
18061 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18062 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18063 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18064
18065 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018066 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018067 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18068 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18069
18070 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18071 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18072 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18073
18074 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18075 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018076 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018077 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18078 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18079 to return the 502 and not the server.
18080
18081 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018082 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018083
18084 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18085 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18086 Nothing was sent to any server.
18087
18088 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18089 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18090
18091 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18092 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018093 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018094 send a 408 return code to the client.
18095
18096 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18097 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18098
18099 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18100 5 seconds ("c----").
18101
18102 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18103 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018104 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018105
18106 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018107 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018108 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18109 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18110 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18111 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18112 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018113
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200181159. Supported filters
18116--------------------
18117
18118Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18119accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18120unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18121
18122See also : "filter"
18123
181249.1. Trace
18125----------
18126
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018127filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018128
18129 Arguments:
18130 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18131 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18132
18133 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18134 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18135 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18136 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18137
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018138 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018139 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18140 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18141 amount of the parsed data.
18142
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018143 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018144
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018145This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18146callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18147information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18148filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18149
18150Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18151tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18152a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18153
18154
181559.2. HTTP compression
18156---------------------
18157
18158filter compression
18159
18160The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18161keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018162when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18163it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18164response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18165line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18166cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18167the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018168
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018169See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018170
18171
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200181729.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18173--------------------------------------------
18174
18175filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18176
18177 Arguments :
18178
18179 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18180 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18181 parsed.
18182
18183 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18184 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18185 part must be placed in its own scope.
18186
18187The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18188external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018189streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018190exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18191also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18192
18193SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18194the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18195
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018196For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018197"doc/SPOE.txt".
18198
18199Important note:
18200 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18201 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18202
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100182039.4. Cache
18204----------
18205
18206filter cache <name>
18207
18208 Arguments :
18209
18210 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18211
18212The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18213"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
18214cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018215other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18216the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18217mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18218filter other than the compression is used for the same
18219listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18220order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018221
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018222See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018223
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001822410. Cache
18225---------
18226
18227HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18228(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18229RAM.
18230
18231The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018232this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018233
18234If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18235independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18236when we try to allocate a new one.
18237
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018238The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018239
18240It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18241"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18242for more details.
18243
18244When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18245replaced by "<CACHE>".
18246
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001824710.1. Limitation
18248----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018249
18250The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18251
18252- If the response is not a 200
18253- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018254- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018255- If the response is not cacheable
18256
18257- If the request is not a GET
18258- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018259- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018260
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018261Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18262filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18263can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18264example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18265"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018266
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001826710.2. Setup
18268-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018269
18270To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18271the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18272
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001827310.2.1. Cache section
18274---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018275
18276cache <name>
18277 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18278 size of cache is mandatory.
18279
18280total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018281 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018282 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018283
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018284max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018285 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18286 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18287 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018288
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018289max-age <seconds>
18290 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18291 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18292 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18293 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18294 default.
18295
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001829610.2.2. Proxy section
18297---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018298
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018299http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018300 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18301 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18302 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18303 after this one.
18304
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018305http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018306 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18307 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18308 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18309 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18310
18311
18312Example:
18313
18314 backend bck1
18315 mode http
18316
18317 http-request cache-use foobar
18318 http-response cache-store foobar
18319 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18320
18321 cache foobar
18322 total-max-size 4
18323 max-age 240
18324
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018325/*
18326 * Local variables:
18327 * fill-column: 79
18328 * End:
18329 */